blob: 147a9fbe7f23a1f96c822ec19840491951984680 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau608efa12016-10-25 22:22:00 +02007 2016/10/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100564 - wurfl-data-file
565 - wurfl-information-list
566 - wurfl-information-list-separator
567 - wurfl-engine-mode
568 - wurfl-cache-size
569 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100570
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200572 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200574 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100575 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100576 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100577 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200578 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200579 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200580 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200581 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - noepoll
583 - nokqueue
584 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100585 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300586 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000587 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200588 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200589 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200590 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - tune.buffers.limit
592 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200593 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200594 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100595 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100596 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200597 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100598 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100599 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100600 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100601 - tune.lua.session-timeout
602 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200603 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100604 - tune.maxaccept
605 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200606 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200607 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200608 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100609 - tune.rcvbuf.client
610 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100611 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100612 - tune.sndbuf.client
613 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100614 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100615 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200616 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100617 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200618 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200619 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200620 - tune.vars.global-max-size
621 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
622 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
623 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100624 - tune.zlib.memlevel
625 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627 * Debugging
628 - debug
629 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200630
631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006323.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633------------------------------------
634
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200635ca-base <dir>
636 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200637 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
638 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200639
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200640chroot <jail dir>
641 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
642 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
643 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
644 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
645 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
646 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100647
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100648cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
649 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
650 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
651 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100652 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
653 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
654 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
655 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
656 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
657 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
658 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
659 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
660 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
661 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100662
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200663crt-base <dir>
664 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
665 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
666 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
667
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200668daemon
669 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
670 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
671 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
672
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200673deviceatlas-json-file <path>
674 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
675 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
676
677deviceatlas-log-level <value>
678 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
679 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
680
681deviceatlas-separator <char>
682 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
683 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
684
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100685deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200686 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
687 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
688 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100689
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900690external-check
691 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
692 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
693 See "option external-check".
694
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695gid <number>
696 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
697 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
698 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100699 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
700 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703group <group name>
704 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
705 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100706
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200707log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200708 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
709 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100710 configured with "log global".
711
712 <address> can be one of:
713
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100714 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100715 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
716 port).
717
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100718 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
719 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
720 port).
721
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100722 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
723 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
724 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
725 writeable).
726
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200727 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
728 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100729
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200730 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
731 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
732 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
733 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
734 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
735 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
736 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
737 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
738 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
739 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
740 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
741
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200742 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
743 one of the following :
744
745 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
746 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
747
748 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
749 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
750
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100751 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752
753 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
754 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
755 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
756
757 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200758 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
759 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
760 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
761 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
762 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
763 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200765 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200766
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100767log-send-hostname [<string>]
768 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
769 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
770 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
771 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
772 the logs.
773
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000774log-tag <string>
775 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
776 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
777 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100778 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000779
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100780lua-load <file>
781 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
782 used multiple times.
783
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200784nbproc <number>
785 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
786 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
787 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
788 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
789 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
790
791pidfile <pidfile>
792 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
793 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
794 starting the process. See also "daemon".
795
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100796presetenv <name> <value>
797 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
798 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
799 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
800 and "unsetenv".
801
802resetenv [<name> ...]
803 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
804 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
805 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
806 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
807 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
808 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
809 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
810 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
811
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100812stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200813 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
814 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
815 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
816 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
817 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
818 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100819 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200820 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
821 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200822
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200823server-state-base <directory>
824 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200825 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
826 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200827
828server-state-file <file>
829 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
830 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
831 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
832 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
833 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
834 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
835 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
836 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200837 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
838 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200839
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100840setenv <name> <value>
841 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
842 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
843 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
844 and "unsetenv".
845
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100846ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
848 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300849 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100850 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
851 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
852 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
853 "bind" keyword for more information.
854
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100855ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
857 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
858 keyword to see available options.
859
860 Example:
861 global
862 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
863
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100864ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
866 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300867 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100868 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
869 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
870 information.
871
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100872ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
873 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
874 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
875 keyword to see available options.
876
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200877ssl-dh-param-file <file>
878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
879 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
880 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
881 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
882 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200883 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
884 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
885 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
886 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200887 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
888 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
889 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
890
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100891ssl-server-verify [none|required]
892 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
893 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
894 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
895
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200896stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
897 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
898 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
899 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200900 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
901 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200902
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200903 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
904 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
905 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200906
907stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
908 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
909 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100910 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200911
912stats maxconn <connections>
913 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
914 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
915
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200916uid <number>
917 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
918 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
919 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
920 one. See also "gid" and "user".
921
922ulimit-n <number>
923 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
924 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
925 option.
926
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100927unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
928 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
929
930 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
931 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
932 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
933 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
934 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
935 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
936 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
937 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
938 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
939 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
940
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100941unsetenv [<name> ...]
942 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
943 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
944 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
945 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
946 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
947 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
948 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
949
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200950user <user name>
951 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
952 See also "uid" and "group".
953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200954node <name>
955 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
956
957 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
958 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
959 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
960 traffic.
961
962description <text>
963 Add a text that describes the instance.
964
965 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
966 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
967 "<" and ">" characters.
968
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096951degrees-data-file <file path>
970 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
971 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
972
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200973 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100974 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
975
97651degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
977 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
978 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
979 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
980
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200981 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100982 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
983
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020098451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100985 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
986 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
987
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200988 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
989 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
990
99151degrees-cache-size <number>
992 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
993 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
994 By default, this cache is disabled.
995
996 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100997 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
998
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100999wurfl-data-file <file path>
1000 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1001 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1002
1003 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1004 with USE_WURFL=1.
1005
1006wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1007 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1008 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1009 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1010
1011 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1012
1013 Valid WURFL properties are:
1014 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1015
1016 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1017 device.
1018
1019 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1020 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1021
1022 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1023 particular web request.
1024
1025 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1026 used Libwurfl API version.
1027
1028 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1029 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1030 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1031
1032 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1033 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1034
1035 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1036 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1037
1038 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1039
1040 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1041
1042 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1043 with USE_WURFL=1.
1044
1045wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1046 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1047 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1048
1049 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1050 with USE_WURFL=1.
1051
1052wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1053 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1054 thus before the chroot.
1055
1056 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1057 with USE_WURFL=1.
1058
1059wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1060 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1061 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1062 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1063 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1064 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1065 mode is enabled by default.
1066
1067 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1068 with USE_WURFL=1.
1069
1070wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1071 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1072 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1073 - "0" : no cache is used.
1074 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1075 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1076 the highest performing option.
1077
1078 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1079 with USE_WURFL=1.
1080
1081wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1082 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1083 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1084
1085 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1086 with USE_WURFL=1.
1087
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010893.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090-----------------------
1091
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001092max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1093 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1094 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1095 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1096 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1097 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1098 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1099 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1100 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1101
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102maxconn <number>
1103 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1104 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1105 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001106 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1107 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1108 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1109 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001110 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1111 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1112 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1113 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1114 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001116maxconnrate <number>
1117 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1118 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1119 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1120 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1121 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1122 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1123 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1124 fairness.
1125
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001126maxcomprate <number>
1127 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001128 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001129 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1130 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1131 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1132 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1133 default value.
1134
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001135maxcompcpuusage <number>
1136 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1137 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1138 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1139 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1140 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1141 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1142 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1143 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1144
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001145maxpipes <number>
1146 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1147 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1148 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1149 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1150 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1151 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1152
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001153maxsessrate <number>
1154 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1155 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1156 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1157 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1158 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1159 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1160 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1161 fairness.
1162
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001163maxsslconn <number>
1164 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1165 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1166 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1167 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1168 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1169 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1170 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001171 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1172 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1173 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1174 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1175 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1176 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1177 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001178
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001179maxsslrate <number>
1180 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1181 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1182 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1183 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1184 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1185 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1186 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1187 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1188 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1189 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1190
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001191maxzlibmem <number>
1192 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1193 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1194 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001195 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1196 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1197 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1198
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001199noepoll
1200 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1201 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001202 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203
1204nokqueue
1205 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1206 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1207 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1208
1209nopoll
1210 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1211 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001212 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001213 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001214
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001215nosplice
1216 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1217 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1218 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001219 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001220 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1221 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1222 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1223 "option splice-response".
1224
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001225nogetaddrinfo
1226 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1227 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1228
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001229noreuseport
1230 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1231 command line argument "-dR".
1232
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001233spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001234 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1235 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1236 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1237 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1238 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1239 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001240
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001241tune.buffers.limit <number>
1242 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1243 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1244 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1245 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1246 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1247 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1248 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1249 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1250 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1251 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1252 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1253 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1254 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1255 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1256 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1257
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001258tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1259 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1260 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1261 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1262 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1263
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001264tune.bufsize <number>
1265 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1266 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1267 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1268 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1269 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1270 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1271 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1272 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001273 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1274 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1275 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001276
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001277tune.chksize <number>
1278 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1279 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1280 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1281 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1282 checks whenever possible.
1283
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001284tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1285 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1286 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1287 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1288 this value. The default value is 1.
1289
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001290tune.http.cookielen <number>
1291 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1292 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1293 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1294 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1295 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1296 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1297 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1298 to change this value.
1299
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001300tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1301 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1302 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1303 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1304 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1305 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1306 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1307 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1308 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1309 limit too high.
1310
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001311tune.idletimer <timeout>
1312 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1313 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1314 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1315 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1316 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1317 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1318 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1319 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1320 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1321
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001322tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1323 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1324 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1325 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1326 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1327 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1328 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1329 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1330
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001331tune.lua.maxmem
1332 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1333 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1334 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1335 memory.
1336
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001337tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1338 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001339 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1340 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1341 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001342
1343tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1344 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1345 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1346 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1347 check servers.
1348
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001349tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1350 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1351 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1352 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1353 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1354
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001355tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001356 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1357 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1358 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1359 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1360 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1361 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1362 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1363 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1364 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1365 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001366
1367tune.maxpollevents <number>
1368 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1369 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1370 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1371 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1372 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1373
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001374tune.maxrewrite <number>
1375 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1376 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1377 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1378 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1379 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1380 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1381 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1382 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1383 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1384 bufsize.
1385
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001386tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1387 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1388 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1389 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1390 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1391 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1392 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1393 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1394 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1395 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1396 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1397 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1398 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1399 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1400 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1401 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1402 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1403 setting this parameter to 0.
1404
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001405tune.pipesize <number>
1406 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1407 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1408 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1409 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1410 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1411 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1412
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001413tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1414tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1415 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1416 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1417 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1418 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1419 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1420 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1421 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1422
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001423tune.recv_enough <number>
1424 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1425 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1426 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1427 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1428 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1429
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001430tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1431tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1432 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1433 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1434 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1435 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1436 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1437 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1438 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1439 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1440 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1441 notifying haproxy again.
1442
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001443tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001444 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1445 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1446 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001447 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001448 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1449 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1450 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1451 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1452 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001453 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1454 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001455
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001456tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1457 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1458 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1459 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1460 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1461 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1462 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1463
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001464tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1465 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001466 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001467 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1468 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1469 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1470 being used for too long.
1471
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001472tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1473 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1474 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1475 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1476 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1477 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1478 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1479 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1480 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1481 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1482 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001483 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1484 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001485
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001486tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1487 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1488 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1489 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1490 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1491 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1492 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1493 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001494 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1495 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001496
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001497tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1498 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1499 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1500 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1501 1000 entries.
1502
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001503tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1504tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1505tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1506tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001507 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1508 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1509 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1510 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1511 response processing.
1512 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1513 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1514 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001515
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001516 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1517 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1518 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1519 all available space is consumed.
1520 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1521 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1522 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001523
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001524tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1525 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001526 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001527 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1528 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1529 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1530
1531tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1532 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1533 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1534 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1535 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015373.3. Debugging
1538--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001539
1540debug
1541 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1542 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1543 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1544 system startup.
1545
1546quiet
1547 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1548 line argument "-q".
1549
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015513.4. Userlists
1552--------------
1553It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1554http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1555it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1556
1557userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001558 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001559 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1560
1561group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001562 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001563 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1564 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1565
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001566user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1567 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001568 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1569 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001570 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1571 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001572 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001573 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001574
1575
1576 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001577 userlist L1
1578 group G1 users tiger,scott
1579 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001580
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001581 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1582 user scott insecure-password elgato
1583 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001584
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001585 userlist L2
1586 group G1
1587 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001588
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001589 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1590 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1591 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001592
1593 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001594
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001595
15963.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001597----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001598It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1599several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1600instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1601values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1602automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1603In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1604using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1605tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1606reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1607Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1608that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1609each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001610
1611peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001612 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001613 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1614
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001615disabled
1616 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1617 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1618 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1619
1620enable
1621 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1622
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001623peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1624 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1625 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1626 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1627 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1628 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1629 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1630
1631 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1632 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1633
1634 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1635 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1636 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1637 across all peers.
1638
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001639 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1640 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001641
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001642 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001643 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001644 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1645 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1646 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001647
1648 backend mybackend
1649 mode tcp
1650 balance roundrobin
1651 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1652 stick on src
1653
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001654 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1655 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001656
1657
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016583.6. Mailers
1659------------
1660It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1661If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1662in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1663
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001664mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001665 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1666 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1667
1668mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1669 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1670
1671 Example:
1672 mailers mymailers
1673 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1674 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1675
1676 backend mybackend
1677 mode tcp
1678 balance roundrobin
1679
1680 email-alert mailers mymailers
1681 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1682 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1683
1684 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1685 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1686
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001687timeout mail <time>
1688 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1689 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1690 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1691 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1692
1693 Example:
1694 mailers mymailers
1695 timeout mail 20s
1696 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001699----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001702 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001703 - frontend <name>
1704 - backend <name>
1705 - listen <name>
1706
1707A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1708its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1709section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001710section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001711
1712A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1713connections.
1714
1715A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1716to forward incoming connections.
1717
1718A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1719parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1722'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1723case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1724
1725Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1726logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1727proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1728However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1729name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1730
1731Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1732and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001733bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001734protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1735modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1736arbitrary criteria.
1737
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001738In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1739a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1740the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1741
1742 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1743 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1744 between responses and new requests.
1745
1746 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1747 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1748 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1749 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1750
1751 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1752 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1753 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1754
1755 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1756 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1757 client-facing connection remains open.
1758
1759 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1760 after the end of the response.
1761
1762The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1763frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1764following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1765weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1766
1767 Backend mode
1768
1769 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1770 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1771 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1772 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1773 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1774 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1775 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1776 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1777 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1778 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1779 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017834.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1784--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001786The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1787limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1788they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1789limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001790marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001791option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001792and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1793with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1794specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001796
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001797 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1798------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1799acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001800appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001801backlog X X X -
1802balance X - X X
1803bind - X X -
1804bind-process X X X X
1805block - X X X
1806capture cookie - X X -
1807capture request header - X X -
1808capture response header - X X -
1809clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001810compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001811contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1812cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001813declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001814default-server X - X X
1815default_backend X X X -
1816description - X X X
1817disabled X X X X
1818dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001819email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001820email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001821email-alert mailers X X X X
1822email-alert myhostname X X X X
1823email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001824enabled X X X X
1825errorfile X X X X
1826errorloc X X X X
1827errorloc302 X X X X
1828-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1829errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001830force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001831filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001832fullconn X - X X
1833grace X X X X
1834hash-type X - X X
1835http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001836http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001837http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001838http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001839http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001840http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001841http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001842id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001843ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001844load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001845log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001846log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001847log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001848log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001849max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001850maxconn X X X -
1851mode X X X X
1852monitor fail - X X -
1853monitor-net X X X -
1854monitor-uri X X X -
1855option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1856option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1857option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1858option allbackups (*) X - X X
1859option checkcache (*) X - X X
1860option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1861option contstats (*) X X X -
1862option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1863option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1864option forceclose (*) X X X X
1865-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1866option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001867option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001868option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001869option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001870option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001871option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001872option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001873option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001874option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1875option httpchk X - X X
1876option httpclose (*) X X X X
1877option httplog X X X X
1878option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001879option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001880option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001881option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001882option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1883option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1884option logasap (*) X X X -
1885option mysql-check X - X X
1886option nolinger (*) X X X X
1887option originalto X X X X
1888option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001889option pgsql-check X - X X
1890option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001891option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001892option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001893option smtpchk X - X X
1894option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1895option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1896option splice-request (*) X X X X
1897option splice-response (*) X X X X
1898option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1899option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1900-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001901option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001902option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1903option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1904option tcpka X X X X
1905option tcplog X X X X
1906option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001907external-check command X - X X
1908external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001909persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1910rate-limit sessions X X X -
1911redirect - X X X
1912redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1913redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1914reqadd - X X X
1915reqallow - X X X
1916reqdel - X X X
1917reqdeny - X X X
1918reqiallow - X X X
1919reqidel - X X X
1920reqideny - X X X
1921reqipass - X X X
1922reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001923reqitarpit - X X X
1924reqpass - X X X
1925reqrep - X X X
1926-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001927reqtarpit - X X X
1928retries X - X X
1929rspadd - X X X
1930rspdel - X X X
1931rspdeny - X X X
1932rspidel - X X X
1933rspideny - X X X
1934rspirep - X X X
1935rsprep - X X X
1936server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001937server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001938source X - X X
1939srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001940stats admin - X X X
1941stats auth X X X X
1942stats enable X X X X
1943stats hide-version X X X X
1944stats http-request - X X X
1945stats realm X X X X
1946stats refresh X X X X
1947stats scope X X X X
1948stats show-desc X X X X
1949stats show-legends X X X X
1950stats show-node X X X X
1951stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001952-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1953stick match - - X X
1954stick on - - X X
1955stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001956stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001957stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001958tcp-check connect - - X X
1959tcp-check expect - - X X
1960tcp-check send - - X X
1961tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001962tcp-request connection - X X -
1963tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001964tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001965tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001966tcp-response content - - X X
1967tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001968timeout check X - X X
1969timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001970timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001971timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1972timeout connect X - X X
1973timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1974timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1975timeout http-request X X X X
1976timeout queue X - X X
1977timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001978timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001979timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1980timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001981timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001982transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001983unique-id-format X X X -
1984unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001985use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001986use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001987------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1988 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1992---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
1994This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1995
1996
1997acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1998 Declare or complete an access list.
1999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2000 no | yes | yes | yes
2001 Example:
2002 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2003 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2004 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002006 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
2008
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002009appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2010 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2013 no | no | yes | yes
2014 Arguments :
2015 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2016 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2017
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002018 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019 checked in each cookie value.
2020
2021 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2022 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2023 milliseconds.
2024
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002025 request-learn
2026 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2027 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2028 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2029 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2030 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2031 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2032
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002033 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2034 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2035 data following this prefix.
2036
2037 Example :
2038 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2039
2040 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2041 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2042
2043 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2044 2 modes are currently supported :
2045 - path-parameters :
2046 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2047 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2048 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2049 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2050 - query-string :
2051 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2052 query string.
2053
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002054 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2055 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2056 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002058 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2059 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
2061
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002062backlog <conns>
2063 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2065 yes | yes | yes | no
2066 Arguments :
2067 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2068 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002069 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002070
2071 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2072 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2073 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2074 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2075 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2076 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2077 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2078 backlog parameter.
2079
2080 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2081 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2082 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2083
2084 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2085
2086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002087balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002088balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2091 yes | no | yes | yes
2092 Arguments :
2093 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2094 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2095 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2096 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2097
2098 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2099 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2100 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2101 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002102 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002103 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002104 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2105 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2106 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2107 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2108 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2109 it, so that you don't worry.
2110
2111 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2112 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2113 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2114 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2115 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2116 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2117 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2118 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002119
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002120 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2121 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2122 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2123 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2124 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2125 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2126 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2127 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2128
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002129 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002130 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002131 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2132 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002133 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002134 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2135 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2136 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2137 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2138 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002139 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2140 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2141 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2142 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2143 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2144 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2147 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2148 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2149 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2150 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2151 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2152 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2153 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002154 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002155 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002156 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2157 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2158 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002160 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2161 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2162 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2163 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2164 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2165 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2166 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2167 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2168 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2169 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2170 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2171 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002172
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002173 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002174 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2175 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2176 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2177 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2178 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2179 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2180 URIs start with a leading "/".
2181
2182 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2183 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2184 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2185 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2186
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002187 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002188 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2189
2190 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002191 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2192 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002193 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2194 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2195 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2196 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002197 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002198 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2199 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002200
2201 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2202 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2203 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2204 server will receive the request.
2205
2206 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2207 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2208 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2209 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2210 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002211 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2212 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2213 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002214
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002215 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2216 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2217 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2218 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2219 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002221 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002222 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2223 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2224 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2225
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002226 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2227 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2228 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2229
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002230 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002231 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002232 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2233 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2234 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2235 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2236 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2237 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002238 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002239 used instead.
2240
2241 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2242 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2243 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2244 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2245
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002246 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2247 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2248 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2249
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002250 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002252 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002253 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2254 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002255
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002256 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2257 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2258 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259
2260 Examples :
2261 balance roundrobin
2262 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002263 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002264 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2265 balance hdr(host)
2266 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002267
2268 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2269 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002271 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002272 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2273 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2274 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2275 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2276
2277 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2278 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2279 defaults to 16 kB.
2280
2281 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2282 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2283
2284 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2285 Round Robin.
2286
2287 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2288 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2289 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2290 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2291
2292 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2293
2294 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002295 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002296 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2297 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2298 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002300 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002301
2302
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002303bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2304bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2307 no | yes | yes | no
2308 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002309 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2310 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2311 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2312 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002313 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002314 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2315 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2316 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2317 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2318 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2319 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2320 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002321 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2322 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2323 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2324 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2325 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2326 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2327 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002328 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2329 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2330 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002331 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2332 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2333 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002334
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002335 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2336 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002337 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2338 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2339 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002340 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2341 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2342 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2343 the range.
2344
2345 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2346 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2347 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2348 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2349 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2350 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2351 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002352 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002353 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002354
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002355 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2356 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2357 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2358 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2359 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2360 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2361 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2362 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2363
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002364 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2365 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2366 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2367 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2370 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2371 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2372 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2373 in a frontend.
2374
2375 Example :
2376 listen http_proxy
2377 bind :80,:443
2378 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002379 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002381 listen http_https_proxy
2382 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002383 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002384
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002385 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2386 bind ipv6@:80
2387 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2388 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2389
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002390 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002391 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002392
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002393 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2394 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2395 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2396 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2397 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2398
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002399 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002400 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401
2402
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002403bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002404 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2406 yes | yes | yes | yes
2407 Arguments :
2408 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2409 may be used to override a default value.
2410
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002411 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002412 option may be combined with other numbers.
2413
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002414 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002415 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2416 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2417 missing from all processes.
2418
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002419 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002420 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002421 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2422 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2423 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2424 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002425
2426 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2427 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2428 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2429 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2430 and 'even' instances.
2431
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002432 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2433 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2434 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2435 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002436
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002437 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2438 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2439
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002440 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2441 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2442 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2443
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002444 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2445 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2446
2447 Example :
2448 listen app_ip1
2449 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002450 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002451
2452 listen app_ip2
2453 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002454 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002455
2456 listen management
2457 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002458 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002459
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002460 listen management
2461 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2462 bind-process 1-4
2463
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002464 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002465
2466
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002467block { if | unless } <condition>
2468 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2470 no | yes | yes | yes
2471
2472 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2473 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002474 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002475 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002476 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2477 "block" statements per instance.
2478
2479 Example:
2480 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2481 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2482 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2483 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002485 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002486
2487
2488capture cookie <name> len <length>
2489 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2491 no | yes | yes | no
2492 Arguments :
2493 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2494 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2495 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2496 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2497 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2498
2499 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2500 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2501 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2502 right if it exceeds <length>.
2503
2504 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2505 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2506 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2507 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2508
2509 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2510 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2511 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2512
2513 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2514 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2515 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002516 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2517 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2518 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519
2520 Example:
2521 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2522
2523 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002524 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002525
2526
2527capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002528 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2530 no | yes | yes | no
2531 Arguments :
2532 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002533 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002534 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2535 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2536 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2537
2538 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2539 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2540 it exceeds <length>.
2541
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002542 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002543 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2544 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002545 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2546 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2547 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2548 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002549 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002550 environments to find where the request came from.
2551
2552 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2553 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2554 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2555 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002557 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2558 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2559 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2560 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2561 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002562
2563 Example:
2564 capture request header Host len 15
2565 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002566 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002568 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569 about logging.
2570
2571
2572capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002573 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2575 no | yes | yes | no
2576 Arguments :
2577 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002578 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002579 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2580 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2581 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2582
2583 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2584 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2585 it exceeds <length>.
2586
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002587 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2589 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2590 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002591 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2592 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2593 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2594 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002595
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002596 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2597 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2598 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2599 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2600 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601
2602 Example:
2603 capture response header Content-length len 9
2604 capture response header Location len 15
2605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002606 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607 about logging.
2608
2609
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002610clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 yes | yes | yes | no
2614 Arguments :
2615 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2617 as explained at the top of this document.
2618
2619 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2620 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2621 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2622 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2623 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2624 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2625 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2626 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002627 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2629 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2630
2631 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2632 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2633 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2634 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2635 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2636 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2637
2638 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2639 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2640
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002641 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2642 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002643
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002644compression algo <algorithm> ...
2645compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002646compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002647 Enable HTTP compression.
2648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2649 yes | yes | yes | yes
2650 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002651 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2652 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2653 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2654
2655 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002656 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2657 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2658 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002659
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002660 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002661 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002662
2663 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2664 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2665 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2666 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2667 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002668 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002669
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002670 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2671 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2672 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2673 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2674 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2675 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2676 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002677 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002678
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002679 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002680 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002681 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2682 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2683 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2684 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2685 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002686
2687 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2688 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2689 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2690 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2691 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002692 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2693 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2694 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2695 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2696 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002697 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2698 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002699
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002700 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002701 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2702 "Accept-Encoding" header
2703 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002704 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002705 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2706 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002707 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2708 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2709 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2710 "multipart"
2711 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2712 header
2713 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2714 and later
2715 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2716 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002717
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002718 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2719 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002720
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002721 Examples :
2722 compression algo gzip
2723 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002724
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002725
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002726contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002727 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2729 yes | no | yes | yes
2730 Arguments :
2731 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2732 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2733 as explained at the top of this document.
2734
2735 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002736 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002737 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002738 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2739 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2740 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2741 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2742
2743 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2744 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2745 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2746 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2747 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2748 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2749
2750 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2751 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2752 instead.
2753
2754 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2755 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2756
2757
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002758cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002759 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2760 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2763 yes | no | yes | yes
2764 Arguments :
2765 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2766 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2767 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2768 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2769 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2770 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2771 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2772 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2773 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2774
2775 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2776 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2777 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2778 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2779 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2780 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002781 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2782 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2783 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2784 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2785 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002786
2787 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002788 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002789
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002790 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002791 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2792 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2793 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2794 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2795 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2796 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2797 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2798 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2799 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2800 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002801
2802 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2803 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2804 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2805 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2806 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2807 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2808 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2809 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2810 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002811 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002812 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2813 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2814 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002816 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2817 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2818 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002819 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2820 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2821 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2822 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002823 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2824 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2825 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826
2827 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2828 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2829 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2830 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2831 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2832 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2833 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2834 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2835 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2836
2837 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2838 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2839 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2840 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2841 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2842 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2843 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2844 persistence cookie in the cache.
2845 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2846
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002847 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2848 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2849 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2850 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2851 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2852 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2853 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2854 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2855 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2856 they logout.
2857
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002858 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2859 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2860 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2861 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2862
2863 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2864 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2865 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2866 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2867 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2868 this attribute.
2869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002870 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002871 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002872 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2873 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2874 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2875 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2876 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2877 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002878
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002879 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2880 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2881 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2882 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2883 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2884 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2885 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2886 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2887 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2888 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2889 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2890 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2891 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2892 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2893 the site.
2894
2895 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2896 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2897 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2898 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2899 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2900 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2901 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2902 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2903 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2904 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2905 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2906 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2907 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2908 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2909 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2910 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2913 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2914 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2915 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002916
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917 Examples :
2918 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2919 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2920 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002921 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002922
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002923 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002924
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002925
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002926declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2927 Declares a capture slot.
2928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2929 no | yes | yes | no
2930 Arguments:
2931 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2932
2933 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2934 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2935 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2936 for use in the response.
2937
2938 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002939 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002940 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2941
2942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002943default-server [param*]
2944 Change default options for a server in a backend
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | no | yes | yes
2947 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002948 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2949 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2950 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2951 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002952
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002953 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002954 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2955
2956 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002958
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959default_backend <backend>
2960 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2962 yes | yes | yes | no
2963 Arguments :
2964 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2965
2966 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2967 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2968 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2969 will catch all undetermined requests.
2970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002971 Example :
2972
2973 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2974 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2975 default_backend dynamic
2976
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002977 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002978
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002979
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002980description <string>
2981 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 no | yes | yes | yes
2984 Arguments : string
2985
2986 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2987 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2988 it describes.
2989 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2990
2991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992disabled
2993 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2995 yes | yes | yes | yes
2996 Arguments : none
2997
2998 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2999 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3000 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3001 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3002 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3003 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3004 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3005
3006 See also : "enabled"
3007
3008
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003009dispatch <address>:<port>
3010 Set a default server address
3011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3012 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003013 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003014
3015 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3016 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3017 during start-up.
3018
3019 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3020 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3021 possible with normal servers.
3022
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003023 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003024 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3025 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3026 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3027 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3028
3029 See also : "server"
3030
3031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003032enabled
3033 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 yes | yes | yes | yes
3036 Arguments : none
3037
3038 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3039 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3040
3041 See also : "disabled"
3042
3043
3044errorfile <code> <file>
3045 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3047 yes | yes | yes | yes
3048 Arguments :
3049 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003050 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3051 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003052
3053 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003054 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003056 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3057 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003058
3059 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3060 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3061 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3062
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003063 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3066 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3067 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3068 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3069
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003070 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3071 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3072 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3073 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3074 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3075 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3078 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3079 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003080 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3082
3083 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3084
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003085 Example :
3086 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003087 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003088 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3089 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3090
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003091
3092errorloc <code> <url>
3093errorloc302 <code> <url>
3094 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3096 yes | yes | yes | yes
3097 Arguments :
3098 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003099 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003100
3101 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3102 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3103 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3104 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3105 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3106
3107 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3108 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3109 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3110
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003111 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3112
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003113 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3114 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3115 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3116 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003117 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003118 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3119 request.
3120
3121 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3122
3123
3124errorloc303 <code> <url>
3125 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 yes | yes | yes | yes
3128 Arguments :
3129 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3130 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3131
3132 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3133 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3134 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3135 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3136 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3137
3138 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3139 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3140 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3141
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003142 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3143
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003144 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3145 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3146 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3147 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003148 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003149
3150 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3151
3152
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003153email-alert from <emailaddr>
3154 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3155 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3157 yes | yes | yes | yes
3158
3159 Arguments :
3160
3161 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3162
3163 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3164 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3165
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003166 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003167 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3168 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003169
3170
3171email-alert level <level>
3172 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3173 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3175 yes | yes | yes | yes
3176
3177 Arguments :
3178
3179 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3180 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3181 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3182
3183 By default level is alert
3184
3185 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3186 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3187 for the proxy.
3188
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003189 Alerts are sent when :
3190
3191 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3192 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3193 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3194 is notice or lower
3195 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3196 and a health check status update occurs
3197
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003198 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3199 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003200 section 3.6 about mailers.
3201
3202
3203email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3204 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3206 yes | yes | yes | yes
3207
3208 Arguments :
3209
3210 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3211
3212 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3213 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3214
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003215 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3216 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003217
3218
3219email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3220 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3221 mailers.
3222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3223 yes | yes | yes | yes
3224
3225 Arguments :
3226
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003227 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003228
3229 By default the systems hostname is used.
3230
3231 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3232 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3233 for the proxy.
3234
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003235 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3236 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003237
3238
3239email-alert to <emailaddr>
3240 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3241 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3242 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 yes | yes | yes | yes
3244
3245 Arguments :
3246
3247 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3248
3249 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3250 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3251
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003252 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003253 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3254
3255
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003256force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3257 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 no | yes | yes | yes
3260
3261 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3262 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3263 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3264 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3265 marked down for maintenance operations.
3266
3267 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3268 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3269 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3270 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3271 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3272 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3273 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3274 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3275 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3276
3277 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3278 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3279 is used.
3280
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003281 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003282 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003283
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003284
3285filter <name> [param*]
3286 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3288 no | yes | yes | yes
3289 Arguments :
3290 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3291 referenced in section 9.
3292
3293 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3294 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3295 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3296 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3297
3298 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3299 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3300
3301 Example:
3302 listen
3303 bind *:80
3304
3305 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3306 filter compression
3307 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3308
3309 compression algo gzip
3310 compression offload
3311
3312 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3313
3314 See also : section 9.
3315
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003316
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003317fullconn <conns>
3318 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3320 yes | no | yes | yes
3321 Arguments :
3322 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3323 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3324
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003325 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003326 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003327 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003328 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3329 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3330 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3331 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3332 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003333 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003334
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003335 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3336 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003337 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3338 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3339 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003340
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003341 Example :
3342 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3343 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3344 # connections.
3345 backend dynamic
3346 fullconn 10000
3347 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3348 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3349
3350 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3351
3352
3353grace <time>
3354 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003356 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003357 Arguments :
3358 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3359 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3360 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3361
3362 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3363 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003364 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003365 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3366
3367 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3368 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3369 simplify it.
3370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003372hash-balance-factor <factor>
3373 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3375 yes | no | no | yes
3376 Arguments :
3377 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3378 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3379 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3380
3381 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3382 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3383 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3384 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3385 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3386 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3387 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3388
3389 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3390 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3391 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3392 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3393 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3394
3395 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3396
3397
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003398hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003399 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 yes | no | yes | yes
3402 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003403 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3404 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003405
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003406 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3407 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3408 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3409 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3410 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3411 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3412 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3413 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3414 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3415 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003416
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003417 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3418 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3419 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3420 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3421 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3422 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3423 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3424 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3425 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3426 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3427 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3428 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3429 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003430 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3431 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003432
3433 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3434
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003435 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003436 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3437 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3438 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003439 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3440 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3441 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003442
3443 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3444 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003445 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3446 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3447 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3448 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3449
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003450 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3451 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3452 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3453 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3454 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3455 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3456 parameter.
3457
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003458 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3459 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3460 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3461 used on strings.
3462
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003463 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3464
3465 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3466 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3467 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3468 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3469 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3470 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3471 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3472 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3473 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3474 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3475 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3476 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003477
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003478 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3479 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3480 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003481
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003482 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003483
3484
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485http-check disable-on-404
3486 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003488 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003489 Arguments : none
3490
3491 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3492 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3493 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3494 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3495 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3496 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3497 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3498 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003499 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3500 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3501 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3502
3503 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3504
3505
3506http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003507 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003509 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003510 Arguments :
3511 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3512 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003513 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003514 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3515 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3516 details on the supported keywords.
3517
3518 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3519 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3520 with the usual backslash ('\').
3521
3522 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3523 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3524 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3525 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3526 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3527
3528 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003529 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003530 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3531 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3532 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3533
3534 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003535 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003536 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3537 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3538 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3539 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3540
3541 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003542 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003543 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3544 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3545 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3546 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3547 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3548 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3549 trace).
3550
3551 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003552 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003553 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3554 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3555 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3556 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3557 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3558 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3559
3560 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3561 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3562 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3563 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3564 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3565 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3566 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3567 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3568
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003569 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3570 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3571 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3572
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003573 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3574 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3575
3576 Examples :
3577 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003578 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003579
3580 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003581 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003582
3583 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003584 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003585
3586 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003587 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003588
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003589 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003590
3591
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003592http-check send-state
3593 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3595 yes | no | yes | yes
3596 Arguments : none
3597
3598 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3599 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3600 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3601 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3602 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3603
3604 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3605 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3606 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3607 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3608 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003609 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3610 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3611 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3612
3613 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3614 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3615 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3616
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003617 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3618 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3619 checked in multiple backends.
3620
3621 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3622 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3623
3624 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3625 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3626 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3627 one fails.
3628
3629 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3630 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3631 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3632
3633 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3634 server's queue.
3635
3636 Example of a header received by the application server :
3637 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3638 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3639
3640 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3641
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003642http-request { allow | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3643 deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003644 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003645 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003646 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003647 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3648 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003649 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3650 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003651 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3652 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3653 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003654 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003655 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003656 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003657 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003658 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003659 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003660 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003661 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003662 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3663
3664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 no | yes | yes | yes
3666
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003667 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3668 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3669 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3670 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3671 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003672
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003673 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3674 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3675 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3676
3677 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003678 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3679 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3680 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3681 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003682
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003683 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3684 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3685 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3686 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3687 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3688 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3689 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3690 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3691 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003692 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003693 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3694 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003695
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003696 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3697 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3698 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3699 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3700 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3701
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003702 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3703 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3704 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003705 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3706 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003707
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003708 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3709 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3710 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3711 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3712 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3713 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3714 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3715 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3716
3717 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3718 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3719 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003720 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3721 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003722
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003723 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3724 <name>.
3725
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003726 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3727 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3728 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3729 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3730 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3731 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3732 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3733 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3734
3735 Example:
3736
3737 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3738
3739 applied to:
3740
3741 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3742
3743 outputs:
3744
3745 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3746
3747 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3748
3749 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3750 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3751 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3752 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3753 header.
3754
3755 Example:
3756
3757 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3758
3759 applied to:
3760
3761 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3762
3763 outputs:
3764
3765 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3766
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003767 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3768 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3769 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3770 it.
3771
3772 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3773 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3774 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3775 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3776 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3777 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3778
3779 Example :
3780 # prepend the host name before the path
3781 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3782
3783 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3784 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3785 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3786 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3787 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3788 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3789 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3790 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3791
3792 Example :
3793 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3794 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3795
3796 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3797 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3798 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3799 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3800 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3801 "set-query".
3802
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003803 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3804 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3805 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3806 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3807 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3808 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3809 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3810 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3811
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003812 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3813 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3814 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3815 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3816 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3817 another equipment.
3818
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003819 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3820 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3821 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3822 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3823 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3824 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3825 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3826 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3827
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003828 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3829 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3830 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3831 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3832 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3833 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3834 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3835 admin privileges.
3836
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003837 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3838 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3839 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3840 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3841 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3842 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3843 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3844 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3845
3846 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3847 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3848 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3849 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3850 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3851 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3852
3853 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3854 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3855 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3856 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3857 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3858 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3859
3860 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3861 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3862 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3863 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3864 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3865 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3866 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3867 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3868 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3869
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003870 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003871 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3872 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3873 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3874 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3875 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3876 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3877 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3878 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3879 request header" for more information.
3880
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003881 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3882 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3883 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3884 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003885 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3886 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003887
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003888 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3889 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3890 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3891 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3892 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3893 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3894 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3895 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3896 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3897 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3898 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3899 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3900
3901 These actions take one or two arguments :
3902 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3903 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3904 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3905 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3906
3907 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3908 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3909 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3910 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3911
3912 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3913 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3914 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3915 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3916 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3917 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3918 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3919 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3920
3921 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3922 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3923 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3924 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3925 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3926
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003927 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3928 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3929 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3930 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3931 continues.
3932
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003933 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3934 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3935 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3936 the actions evaluation continues.
3937
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003938 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3939 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3940 inline.
3941
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003942 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3943 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3944 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3945 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003946 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003947 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003948 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003949 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3950 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003951 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003952 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003953 and '_'.
3954
3955 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3956 followed by some converters.
3957
3958 Example:
3959
3960 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3961
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003962 - set-src <expr> :
3963 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3964 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3965 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3966 source IP for privacy.
3967
3968 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3969 followed by some converters.
3970
3971 Example:
3972
3973 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3974 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3975
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003976 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
3977 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003978
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003979 - set-src-port <expr> :
3980 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3981 expression.
3982
3983 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3984 followed by some converters.
3985
3986 Example:
3987
3988 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
3989 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
3990
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003991 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
3992 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
3993 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003994
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003995 - set-dst <expr> :
3996 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
3997 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
3998 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3999 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4000 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4001
4002 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4003 followed by some converters.
4004
4005 Example:
4006
4007 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4008 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4009
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004010 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4011 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4012
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004013 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4014 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4015 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4016 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4017
4018 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4019 followed by some converters.
4020
4021 Example:
4022
4023 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4024 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4025
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004026 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4027 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4028 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4029
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004030 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4031 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4032 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4033 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4034 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4035 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4036 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4037 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4038 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4039 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4040 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4041 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4042 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4043 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4044 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4045 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4046
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004047 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4048
4049 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4050 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004051 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4052 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4053
4054 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4055 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4056 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4057 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004058
4059 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004060 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4061 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4062 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004063
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004064 http-request allow if nagios
4065 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4066 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4067 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004068
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004069 Example:
4070 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004071 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004072
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004073 Example:
4074 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4075 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004076 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004077 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4078 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4079 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4080 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4081 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4082 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4083
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004084 Example:
4085 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4086 acl add path /addacl
4087 acl del path /delacl
4088
4089 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4090
4091 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4092 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4093
4094 Example:
4095 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4096 acl setmap path /setmap
4097 acl delmap path /delmap
4098
4099 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4100
4101 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4102 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4103
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004104 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4105 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004106
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004107http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004108 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004109 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004110 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4111 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004112 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004113 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4114 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4115 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4116 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004117 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004118 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004119 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004120 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004121 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004122 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004123 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004124 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004125 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4126
4127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4128 no | yes | yes | yes
4129
4130 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4131 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4132 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4133 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4134 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4135 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4136
4137 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4138 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4139 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4140 current section.
4141
4142 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4143 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4144 rules are evaluated.
4145
4146 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4147 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4148 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4149 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4150 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4151 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4152 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4153
4154 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4155 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4156 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4157 external users.
4158
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004159 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4160 <name>.
4161
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004162 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4163 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4164 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4165 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4166 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4167 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4168 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4169 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4170
4171 Example:
4172
4173 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4174
4175 applied to:
4176
4177 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4178
4179 outputs:
4180
4181 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4182
4183 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4184
4185 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4186 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4187 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4188 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4189 header.
4190
4191 Example:
4192
4193 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4194
4195 applied to:
4196
4197 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4198
4199 outputs:
4200
4201 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4202
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004203 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4204 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4205 adapted to the new code.
4206
4207 Example:
4208
4209 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4210 http-response set-status 431
4211
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004212 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4213 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4214 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4215 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4216 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4217 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4218 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4219 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4220
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004221 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4222 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4223 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4224 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4225 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4226 another equipment.
4227
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004228 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4229 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4230 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4231 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4232 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4233 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4234 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4235 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4236
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004237 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4238 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4239 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4240 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4241 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4242 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4243 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4244 admin privileges.
4245
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004246 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4247 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4248 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4249 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4250 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4251 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4252 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4253 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4254
4255 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4256 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4257 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4258 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4259 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4260 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4261
4262 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4263 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4264 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4265 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4266 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4267 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4268
4269 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4270 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4271 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4272 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4273 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4274 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4275 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4276 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4277 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4278
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004279 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4280 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4281 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4282 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4283 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4284 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4285 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4286 response header" for more information.
4287
4288 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4289 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4290 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4291 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4292 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004293 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4294 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004295
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004296 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4297 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4298 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4299 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4300 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4301 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4302
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004303 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4304 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4305 inline.
4306
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004307 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4308 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4309 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4310 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004311 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004312 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004313 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004314 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4315 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004316 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004317 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004318 and '_'.
4319
4320 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4321 followed by some converters.
4322
4323 Example:
4324
4325 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4326
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004327 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4328 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4329 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4330 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4331 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4332 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4333 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4334
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004335 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4336 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4337 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4338 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4339 continues.
4340
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004341 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4342 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4343 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4344 the actions evaluation continues.
4345
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004346 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4347 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4348 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4349 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4350 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4351 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4352 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4353 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4354 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4355 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4356 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4357 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4358 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4359 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4360 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4361 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4362
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004363 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4364
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004365 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004366 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4367 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004368 rules.
4369
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004370 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4371 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4372 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4373 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4374
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004375 Example:
4376 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4377
4378 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4379
4380 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4381 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4382
4383 Example:
4384 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4385
4386 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4387
4388 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4389 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4390
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004391 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4392 ACL usage.
4393
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004394
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004395http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4396 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4397
4398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | no | yes | yes
4400
4401 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4402 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4403 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4404 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4405 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4406 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4407
4408 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4409
4410 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4411 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4412 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4413 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4414 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4415 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4416 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4417 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4418 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4419 not checking any request past the first one.
4420
4421 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4422 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4423 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4424 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4425 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4426 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4427 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4428
4429 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4430 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4431 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4432 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4433 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4434 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4435 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4436 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4437 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4438 downsides of rare connection failures.
4439
4440 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4441 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4442 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4443 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4444 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4445 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4446 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4447 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4448 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4449 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4450 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4451 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4452
4453 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4454 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4455 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4456 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4457
4458 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4459 and are never shared ;
4460
4461 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4462 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4463 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4464 and are never shared ;
4465
4466 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4467 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4468 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4469
4470 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4471 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4472 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4473
4474 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4475
4476
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004477http-send-name-header [<header>]
4478 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4479
4480 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 yes | no | yes | yes
4482
4483 Arguments :
4484
4485 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4486
4487 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4488 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4489 is added with the header string proved.
4490
4491 See also : "server"
4492
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004493id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004494 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4496 no | yes | yes | yes
4497 Arguments : none
4498
4499 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4500 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4501 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004502
4503
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004504ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4505 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4507 no | yes | yes | yes
4508
4509 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4510 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4511 and running).
4512
4513 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4514 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4515 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004516 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004517 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4518
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004519 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4520 "unless" condition is met.
4521
4522 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4523
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004524load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4525 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4526 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4527 yes | no | yes | yes
4528
4529 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4530 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4531 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4532 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4533 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4534 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4535 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4536 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4537
4538 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4539 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004540 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004541
4542 Arguments:
4543 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4544 named "server-state-file".
4545
4546 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4547 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4548 name is used as a file name.
4549
4550 none don't load any stat for this backend
4551
4552 Notes:
4553 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4554 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4555 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4556
4557 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4558 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4559
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004560 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004561
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004562 global
4563 stats socket /tmp/socket
4564 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004565
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004566 defaults
4567 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004568
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004569 backend bk
4570 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4571 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004572
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004573
4574 Then one can run :
4575
4576 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4577
4578 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4579
4580 1
4581 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4582 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4583 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4584
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004585 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004586
4587 global
4588 stats socket /tmp/socket
4589 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4590
4591 defaults
4592 load-server-state-from-file local
4593
4594 backend bk
4595 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4596 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4597
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004598
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004599 Then one can run :
4600
4601 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4602
4603 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4604
4605 1
4606 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4607 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4608 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4609
4610 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4611 "show servers state"
4612
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004614log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004615log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004616no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004617 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4619 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004620
4621 Prefix :
4622 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4623 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4624 prefix does not allow arguments.
4625
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004626 Arguments :
4627 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4628 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4629 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4630 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4631 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4632 parameter.
4633
4634 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4635 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4636
4637 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4638 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4639 standard syslog port).
4640
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004641 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4642 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4643 standard syslog port).
4644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004645 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4646 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4647 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4648 appropriately writeable).
4649
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004650 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4651 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004652
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004653 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4654 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4655 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4656 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4657 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4658 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4659 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4660 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4661 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4662 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4663 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4664
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004665 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4666
4667 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4668 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4669 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4670
4671 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4672 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4673 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004674 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4675 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4676 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4677 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4678 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004679
4680 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4681
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004682 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4683 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4684 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004685
4686 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4687 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4688 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4689 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4690
4691 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4692 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004693
4694 Example :
4695 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004696 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4697 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004698 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004699
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004700
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004701log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004702 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4704 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004705
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004706 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4707 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4708 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4709 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4710 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004711
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004712log-format-sd <string>
4713 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4714 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4715 yes | yes | yes | no
4716
4717 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4718 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4719 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4720 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4721 which covers the log format string in depth.
4722
4723 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4724 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4725
4726 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4727 log format to "rfc5424".
4728
4729 Example :
4730 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4731
4732
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004733log-tag <string>
4734 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4735 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4736 yes | yes | yes | yes
4737
4738 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4739 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4740 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4741 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4742 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4743 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4744 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4745 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4746 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004747
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004748max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4749 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4750 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | no | yes | yes
4752
4753 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4754 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4755 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4756 servers.
4757
4758 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4759 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4760 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4761 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4762 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4763 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4764 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4765 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4766 picking a different server.
4767
4768 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4769 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4770 even if they have to be queued.
4771
4772 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4773 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4774
4775
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004776maxconn <conns>
4777 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4779 yes | yes | yes | no
4780 Arguments :
4781 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4782 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4783 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4784 closes.
4785
4786 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4787 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4788 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4789 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004790 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4791 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4792 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4793 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004794
4795 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4796 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4797 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4798
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004799 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4800
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004801 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4802
4803
4804mode { tcp|http|health }
4805 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 yes | yes | yes | yes
4808 Arguments :
4809 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4810 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4811 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4812 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4813
4814 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4815 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4816 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4817 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4818 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4819
4820 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004821 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4822 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4823 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4824 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4825 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4826 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4827 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004828
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004829 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4830 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4831 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004832
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004833 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004834 defaults http_instances
4835 mode http
4836
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004837 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004838
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004839
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004840monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004841 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4843 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844 Arguments :
4845 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4846 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004847 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004848 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4849 backend and its backup.
4850
4851 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4852 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4853 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4854 servers in a list of backends.
4855
4856 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4857 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4858 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4859 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4860 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4861 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4862 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004863 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4864 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004865
4866 Example:
4867 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004868 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004869 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4870 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4871 monitor-uri /site_alive
4872 monitor fail if site_dead
4873
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004874 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004875
4876
4877monitor-net <source>
4878 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4880 yes | yes | yes | no
4881 Arguments :
4882 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4883 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4884 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4885 followed by a mask.
4886
4887 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4888 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004889 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004890 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4891
4892 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4893 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4894 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4895 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004896 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4897 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4898 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004899
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004900 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4901 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4902 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4903 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4904 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4905 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004906
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004907 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4908 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004909
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004910 Example :
4911 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4912 frontend www
4913 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4914
4915 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4916
4917
4918monitor-uri <uri>
4919 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4921 yes | yes | yes | no
4922 Arguments :
4923 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4924 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4925
4926 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4927 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4928 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4929 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4930 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4931 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4932 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4933 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4934
4935 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4936 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4937 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4938 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4939 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4940 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4941
4942 Example :
4943 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4944 frontend www
4945 mode http
4946 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4947
4948 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004950
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004951option abortonclose
4952no option abortonclose
4953 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4955 yes | no | yes | yes
4956 Arguments : none
4957
4958 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4959 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4960 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4961 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004962 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004963 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4964 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4965 encountered while delivering the response.
4966
4967 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4968 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4969 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4970 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4971 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4972 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004973 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004974 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004975 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004976 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4977 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4978 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4979
4980 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4981 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4982 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4983 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4984 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4985 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4986 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4987 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004988 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004989
4990 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4991 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4992
4993 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4994
4995
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004996option accept-invalid-http-request
4997no option accept-invalid-http-request
4998 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5000 yes | yes | yes | no
5001 Arguments : none
5002
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005003 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005004 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5005 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5006 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5007 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5008 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5009 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5010 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005011 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5012 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5013 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5014 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5015 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005016 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005017 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5018 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5019 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005020
5021 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5022 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5023 been confirmed.
5024
5025 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5026 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005027 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5028 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005029 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5030
5031 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5032 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5033
5034 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5035 stats socket.
5036
5037
5038option accept-invalid-http-response
5039no option accept-invalid-http-response
5040 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5042 yes | no | yes | yes
5043 Arguments : none
5044
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005045 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005046 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5047 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5048 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5049 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5050 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5051 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5052 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005053 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5054 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5055 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005056
5057 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5058 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5059 been confirmed.
5060
5061 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5062 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5063 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5064 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5065
5066 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5067 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5068
5069 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5070 stats socket.
5071
5072
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005073option allbackups
5074no option allbackups
5075 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5077 yes | no | yes | yes
5078 Arguments : none
5079
5080 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5081 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5082 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5083 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5084 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5085 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5086 order between the backup servers anymore.
5087
5088 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5089 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5090
5091 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5092 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5093
5094
5095option checkcache
5096no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005097 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5099 yes | no | yes | yes
5100 Arguments : none
5101
5102 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5103 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005104 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005105 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5106 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005107 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005108
5109 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005110 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005111 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005112 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5113 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005114 to the client are :
5115 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005116 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005117 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005118 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5119 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5120 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5121 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5122 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5123 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5124 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5125 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5126 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5127 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5128 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5129
5130 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005131 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005132 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005133 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005134 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5135
5136 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5137 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005138 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005139 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5140
5141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5143
5144
5145option clitcpka
5146no option clitcpka
5147 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5149 yes | yes | yes | no
5150 Arguments : none
5151
5152 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5153 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5154 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5155 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5156
5157 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5158 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5159 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5160 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5161
5162 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5163 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5164 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5165 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5166 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5167
5168 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5169
5170 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5171 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5172 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5173
5174 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5175 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5176
5177 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5178
5179
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005180option contstats
5181 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5183 yes | yes | yes | no
5184 Arguments : none
5185
5186 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5187 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5188 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5189 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005190 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5191 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5192 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5193 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5194 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005195
5196
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005197option dontlog-normal
5198no option dontlog-normal
5199 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5201 yes | yes | yes | no
5202 Arguments : none
5203
5204 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5205 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5206 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5207 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5208 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5209 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5210 logged.
5211
5212 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5213 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5214 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005216 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005217 logging.
5218
5219
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005220option dontlognull
5221no option dontlognull
5222 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5224 yes | yes | yes | no
5225 Arguments : none
5226
5227 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5228 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5229 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5230 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5231 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5232 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005233 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5234 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5235 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005236
5237 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5238 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5239 would not be logged.
5240
5241 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5242 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5243
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005244 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5245 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005246
5247
5248option forceclose
5249no option forceclose
5250 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005252 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005253 Arguments : none
5254
5255 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5256 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5257 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5258 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5259 global session times in the logs.
5260
5261 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005262 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005263 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005264
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005265 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5266 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5267 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5268
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005269 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5270 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005271
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005272 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5273 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5274
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005275 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005276
5277
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005278option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005279 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5281 yes | yes | yes | yes
5282 Arguments :
5283 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5284 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005285 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005286 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005287
5288 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5289 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5290 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5291 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5292 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5293 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5294 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005295 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5296 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5297 possible that the client has already brought one.
5298
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005299 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005300 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005301 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5302 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005303 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5304 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005305
5306 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5307 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5308 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5309 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5310 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5311 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5312 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5313
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005314 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5315 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5316 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5317 are under the control of the end-user.
5318
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005319 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005320 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5321 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005322 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5323 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5324 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005325
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005326 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005327 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5328 frontend www
5329 mode http
5330 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5331
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005332 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5333 backend www
5334 mode http
5335 option forwardfor header X-Client
5336
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005337 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005338 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005339
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005340
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005341option http-buffer-request
5342no option http-buffer-request
5343 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5345 yes | yes | yes | yes
5346 Arguments : none
5347
5348 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5349 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5350 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5351 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5352 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5353 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5354 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5355 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5356 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5357 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5358 default.
5359
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005360 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005361
5362
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005363option http-ignore-probes
5364no option http-ignore-probes
5365 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5367 yes | yes | yes | no
5368 Arguments : none
5369
5370 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5371 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5372 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5373 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5374 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5375 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5376 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5377 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5378 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5379 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5380 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5381 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5382
5383 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5384 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5385 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5386 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5387 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5388 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5389 are often the only way to detect them.
5390
5391 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5392 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5393
5394 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5395
5396
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005397option http-keep-alive
5398no option http-keep-alive
5399 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5401 yes | yes | yes | yes
5402 Arguments : none
5403
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005404 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5405 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5406 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5407 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5408 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5409 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5410 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5411
5412 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5413 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005414 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5415 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5416 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5417 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5418 situations where this option may be useful :
5419
5420 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5421 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5422
5423 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5424 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5425
5426 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5427 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5428 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5429 request.
5430
5431 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5432 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005433 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5434 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5435 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005436
5437 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5438 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5439
5440 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5441 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5442 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5443 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5444 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5445 not set.
5446
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005447 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5448 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005449 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005450 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005451
5452 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005453 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5454 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005455
5456
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005457option http-no-delay
5458no option http-no-delay
5459 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5461 yes | yes | yes | yes
5462 Arguments : none
5463
5464 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5465 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5466 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5467 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5468 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5469 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5470 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5471 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5472 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5473 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5474 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5475 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5476 affected.
5477
5478 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5479 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5480 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5481 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5482 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5483 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5484 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5485 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5486 latency environments.
5487
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005488 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5489
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005490
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005491option http-pretend-keepalive
5492no option http-pretend-keepalive
5493 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5495 yes | yes | yes | yes
5496 Arguments : none
5497
5498 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5499 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5500 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5501 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5502 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5503 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5504 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5505 consider the response complete.
5506
5507 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5508 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5509 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5510 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5511 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5512 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5513
5514 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5515 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5516 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5517 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5518 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5519 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5520 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5521
5522 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5523 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005524 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005525 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5526 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005527
5528 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5529 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5530
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005531 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5532 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005533
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005534
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005535option http-server-close
5536no option http-server-close
5537 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 yes | yes | yes | yes
5540 Arguments : none
5541
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005542 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5543 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5544 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5545 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5546 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5547 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5548 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5549 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5550 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5551 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5552 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5553 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5554 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5555 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5556 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5557 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005558
5559 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5560 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5561 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5562 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005563 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5564 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005565
5566 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5567 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005568 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5569 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005570 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5571 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005572
5573 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5574 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5575
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005576 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005577 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5578 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005579
5580
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005581option http-tunnel
5582no option http-tunnel
5583 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5585 yes | yes | yes | yes
5586 Arguments : none
5587
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005588 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5589 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5590 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5591 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5592 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5593 "option http-tunnel".
5594
5595 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005596 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005597 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5598 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5599 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5600 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5601 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5602 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5603 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005604
5605 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5606 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5607
5608 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5609 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5610 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5611
5612
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005613option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005614no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005615 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5617 yes | yes | yes | no
5618 Arguments : none
5619
5620 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5621 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5622 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5623 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5624 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5625 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5626 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5627
5628 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5629 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005630 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5631 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5632 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005633
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005634 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5635 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5636 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5637 front of an existing proxy.
5638
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005639 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5640
5641 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5642 http-server-close".
5643
5644
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005645option httpchk
5646option httpchk <uri>
5647option httpchk <method> <uri>
5648option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5649 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5651 yes | no | yes | yes
5652 Arguments :
5653 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5654 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5655 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5656 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5657 ones.
5658
5659 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5660 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5661 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5662
5663 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5664 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5665 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5666 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5667 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5668
5669 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5670 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5671 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5672 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5673 the lack of any response.
5674
5675 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5676
5677 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5678 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5679 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5680
5681 Examples :
5682 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5683 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5684 backend https_relay
5685 mode tcp
5686 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5687 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5688
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005689 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5690 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5691 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005692
5693
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005694option httpclose
5695no option httpclose
5696 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5698 yes | yes | yes | yes
5699 Arguments : none
5700
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005701 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5702 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5703 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5704 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005705 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005706 "option http-tunnel".
5707
5708 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5709 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5710 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5711 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5712 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5713 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5714 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5715 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005716
5717 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005718 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005719 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5720 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5721 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5722 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5723 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005724
5725 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5726 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005727 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5728 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005729 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5730 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005731
5732 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5733 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5734
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005735 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5736 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005737
5738
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005739option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005740 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5742 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005743 Arguments :
5744 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5745 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5746 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5747 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5748 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005749
5750 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5751 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5752 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5753 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5754 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5755 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5756 ports.
5757
5758 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5759
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005760 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5761 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005764
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005765
5766option http_proxy
5767no option http_proxy
5768 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5770 yes | yes | yes | yes
5771 Arguments : none
5772
5773 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5774 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5775 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5776 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5777 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5778
5779 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5780 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005781 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5782 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005783
5784 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5785 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5786
5787 Example :
5788 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5789 backend direct_forward
5790 option httpclose
5791 option http_proxy
5792
5793 See also : "option httpclose"
5794
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005795
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005796option independent-streams
5797no option independent-streams
5798 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5800 yes | yes | yes | yes
5801 Arguments : none
5802
5803 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5804 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5805 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5806 receive data or not.
5807
5808 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5809 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5810 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5811 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5812 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5813 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5814 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5815 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5816 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5817 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5818 socket buffers.
5819
5820 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5821 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5822 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5823 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5824 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5825
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005826 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005827 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5828 deprecated.
5829
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005830 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005831
5832
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005833option ldap-check
5834 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5836 yes | no | yes | yes
5837 Arguments : none
5838
5839 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5840 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5841 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5842 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5843
5844 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5845 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5846
5847 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5848 configure it.
5849
5850 Example :
5851 option ldap-check
5852
5853 See also : "option httpchk"
5854
5855
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005856option external-check
5857 Use external processes for server health checks
5858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5859 yes | no | yes | yes
5860
5861 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5862 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5863 command".
5864
5865 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5866
5867 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5868
5869
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005870option log-health-checks
5871no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005872 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5874 yes | no | yes | yes
5875 Arguments : none
5876
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005877 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5878 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5879 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005880
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005881 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5882 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5883 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5884 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5885 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5886
5887 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5888 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005889
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005890 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5891 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5892 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005893
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005894
5895option log-separate-errors
5896no option log-separate-errors
5897 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 yes | yes | yes | no
5900 Arguments : none
5901
5902 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5903 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5904 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5905 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5906 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5907 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5908 provides very important information.
5909
5910 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5911 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5912 error logs.
5913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005914 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005915 logging.
5916
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005917
5918option logasap
5919no option logasap
5920 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5922 yes | yes | yes | no
5923 Arguments : none
5924
5925 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5926 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5927 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5928 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5929 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5930 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5931 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005932 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005933 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5934 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5935
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005936 Examples :
5937 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5938 mode http
5939 option httplog
5940 option logasap
5941 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5942
5943 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5944 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5945 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5946 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005948 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005949 logging.
5950
5951
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005952option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005953 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5955 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005956 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005957 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5958 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005959 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005960
5961 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5962 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5963 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5964 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5965 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5966 in the MySQL table, like this :
5967
5968 USE mysql;
5969 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5970 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5971
5972 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5973 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5974 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5975 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5976 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5977 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5978 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5979 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5980 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5981
5982 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5983 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005984
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005985 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005986
5987 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5988 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5989 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5990 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005991 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5992 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005993
5994 See also: "option httpchk"
5995
5996
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005997option nolinger
5998no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005999 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006000 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6001 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006002 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006003
6004 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6005 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6006 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6007 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6008 connections.
6009
6010 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6011 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6012 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6013 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6014 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6015 this too.
6016
6017 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6018 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6019 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6020
6021 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6022 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6023 for servers.
6024
6025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6027
6028
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006029option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6030 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6032 yes | yes | yes | yes
6033 Arguments :
6034 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6035 matching <network>
6036 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6037 header name.
6038
6039 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6040 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6041 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6042 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6043 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6044 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6045 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6046 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6047 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6048 possible that the client has already brought one.
6049
6050 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6051 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6052 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6053 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6054 header and requires different one.
6055
6056 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6057 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6058 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6059 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6060 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6061 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6062 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6063
6064 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6065 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6066 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6067 both are defined.
6068
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006069 Examples :
6070 # Original Destination address
6071 frontend www
6072 mode http
6073 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6074
6075 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6076 backend www
6077 mode http
6078 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6079
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006080 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6081 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006082
6083
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006084option persist
6085no option persist
6086 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6087 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6088 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006089 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006090
6091 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6092 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6093 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6094 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6095 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6096 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6097 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6098 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6099 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6100 redirected to another valid server.
6101
6102 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6103 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6104
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006105 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006106
6107
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006108option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6109 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6111 yes | no | yes | yes
6112 Arguments :
6113 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6114 PostgreSQL server.
6115
6116 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6117 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6118 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6119 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6120
6121 See also: "option httpchk"
6122
6123
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006124option prefer-last-server
6125no option prefer-last-server
6126 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6128 yes | no | yes | yes
6129 Arguments : none
6130
6131 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6132 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6133 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6134 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6135 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6136 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6137 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6138 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6139 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006140 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6141 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6142 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6143 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6144 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6145 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6146 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006147
6148 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6149 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6150
6151 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6152
6153
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006154option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006155option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006156no option redispatch
6157 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6158 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6159 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006160 Arguments :
6161 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6162 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6163 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6164 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6165 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6166 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6167 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6168 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6169 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6170
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006171
6172 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6173 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6174 be able to access the service anymore.
6175
6176 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6177 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6178
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006179 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006180 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6181 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006183 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6184 "redisp" keywords.
6185
6186 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6187 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6188
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006189 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006190
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006191
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006192option redis-check
6193 Use redis health checks for server testing
6194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6195 yes | no | yes | yes
6196 Arguments : none
6197
6198 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6199 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6200 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6201 find the "+PONG" response message.
6202
6203 Example :
6204 option redis-check
6205
6206 See also : "option httpchk"
6207
6208
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006209option smtpchk
6210option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6211 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6213 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006214 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006215 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6216 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6217 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6218
6219 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6220 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6221 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6222
6223 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6224 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6225 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6226 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6227 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6228 dead server.
6229
6230 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6231 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6232 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6233 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6234
6235 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6236 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6237 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6238 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006239 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006240
6241 Example :
6242 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6243
6244 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6245
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006247option socket-stats
6248no option socket-stats
6249
6250 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 yes | yes | yes | no
6253
6254 Arguments : none
6255
6256
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006257option splice-auto
6258no option splice-auto
6259 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6261 yes | yes | yes | yes
6262 Arguments : none
6263
6264 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6265 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6266 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6267 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006268 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006269 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6270 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6271 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6272 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6273
6274 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6275 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6276 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6277 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6278 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6279 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6280 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6281 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6282 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6283 keyword.
6284
6285 Example :
6286 option splice-auto
6287
6288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6290
6291 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6292 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6293
6294
6295option splice-request
6296no option splice-request
6297 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6299 yes | yes | yes | yes
6300 Arguments : none
6301
6302 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006303 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006304 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6305 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6306 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6307 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6308
6309 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6310
6311 Example :
6312 option splice-request
6313
6314 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6315 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6316
6317 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6318 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6319
6320
6321option splice-response
6322no option splice-response
6323 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6325 yes | yes | yes | yes
6326 Arguments : none
6327
6328 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006329 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006330 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6331 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6332 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6333 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6334
6335 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6336
6337 Example :
6338 option splice-response
6339
6340 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6341 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6342
6343 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6344 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6345
6346
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006347option srvtcpka
6348no option srvtcpka
6349 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6351 yes | no | yes | yes
6352 Arguments : none
6353
6354 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6355 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6356 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6357 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6358
6359 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6360 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6361 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6362 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6363
6364 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6365 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6366 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6367 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6368 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6369
6370 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6371
6372 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6373 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6374 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6375
6376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6378
6379 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6380
6381
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006382option ssl-hello-chk
6383 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6385 yes | no | yes | yes
6386 Arguments : none
6387
6388 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6389 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6390 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6391 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6392 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6393 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6394 hello message.
6395
6396 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6397 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6398 messages, which is appreciable.
6399
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006400 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6401 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6402 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006403
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006404 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6405
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006406
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006407option tcp-check
6408 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6409 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6410 yes | no | yes | yes
6411
6412 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6413 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6414
6415 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6416 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6417 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6418
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006419 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006420 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6421 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6422 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6423 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6424 only.
6425
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006426 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006427 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6428 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6429 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6430 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6431
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006432 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006433 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6434 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006435 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006436 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6437 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6438 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6439 the respective protocols.
6440 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6441 analysed.
6442
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006443 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6444 script.
6445
6446 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6447 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6448 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6449 The "comment" is of course optional.
6450
6451
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006452 Examples :
6453 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6454 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006455 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006456
6457 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6458 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006459 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006460
6461 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6462 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006463 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006464 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006465 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006466 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006467 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006468 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006469 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6470 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006471 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006472 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6473 tcp-check expect string +OK
6474
6475 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6476 (send many headers before analyzing)
6477 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006478 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006479 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6480 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6481 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6482 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006483 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006484
6485
6486 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6487
6488
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006489option tcp-smart-accept
6490no option tcp-smart-accept
6491 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6493 yes | yes | yes | no
6494 Arguments : none
6495
6496 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6497 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6498 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6499 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6500 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6501 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6502
6503 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6504 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6505 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6506 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6507
6508 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6509 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6510 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6511 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6512
6513 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6514 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6515 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6516
6517 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6518 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6519 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6520
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006521 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6522
6523
6524option tcp-smart-connect
6525no option tcp-smart-connect
6526 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6528 yes | no | yes | yes
6529 Arguments : none
6530
6531 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6532 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6533 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6534 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6535 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6536
6537 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6538 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6539 complex.
6540
6541 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6542 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6543 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6544
6545 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6546 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6547
6548 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6549
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006550
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006551option tcpka
6552 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6554 yes | yes | yes | yes
6555 Arguments : none
6556
6557 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6558 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6559 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6560 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6561
6562 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6563 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6564 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6565 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6566
6567 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6568 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6569 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6570 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6571 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6572
6573 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6574
6575 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6576 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6577 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6578 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6579 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6580 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6581 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6582 backends.
6583
6584 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6585
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006586
6587option tcplog
6588 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6590 yes | yes | yes | yes
6591 Arguments : none
6592
6593 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6594 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6595 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6596 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6597 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6598 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6599 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6600 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6601
6602 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006604 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006605
6606
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006607option transparent
6608no option transparent
6609 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006611 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006612 Arguments : none
6613
6614 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6615 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6616 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6617 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6618 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6619 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6620 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6621 appropriate server.
6622
6623 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6624 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6625
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006626 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006627 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006628
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006629
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006630external-check command <command>
6631 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6633 yes | no | yes | yes
6634
6635 Arguments :
6636 <command> is the external command to run
6637
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006638 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6639
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006640 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006641
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006642 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6643 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6644 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6645 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6646 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6647 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006648
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006649 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6650
6651 Environment variables :
6652 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6653 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6654
6655 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6656
6657 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6658
6659 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6660 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6661 for a UNIX socket).
6662
6663 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6664
6665 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6666
6667 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6668
6669 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6670
6671 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6672
6673 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6674 socket).
6675
6676 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6677 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6678
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006679 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6680 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6681 failed.
6682
6683 Example :
6684 external-check command /bin/true
6685
6686 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6687
6688
6689external-check path <path>
6690 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6692 yes | no | yes | yes
6693
6694 Arguments :
6695 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6696
6697 The default path is "".
6698
6699 Example :
6700 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6701
6702 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6703 "external-check command"
6704
6705
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006706persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006707persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006708 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6710 yes | no | yes | yes
6711 Arguments :
6712 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006713 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6714 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006715
6716 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6717 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6718 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6719 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6720 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6721 forwarded to this server.
6722
6723 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6724 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6725 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006726 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006727 a single "listen" section.
6728
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006729 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6730 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6731 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6732
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006733 Example :
6734 listen tse-farm
6735 bind :3389
6736 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6737 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6738 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6739 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6740 persist rdp-cookie
6741 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006742 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006743 balance rdp-cookie
6744 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6745 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6746
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006747 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6748 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006749
6750
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006751rate-limit sessions <rate>
6752 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6754 yes | yes | yes | no
6755 Arguments :
6756 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6757 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6758
6759 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6760 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6761 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6762 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6763 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6764 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6765
6766 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6767 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6768 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6769 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6770
6771 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6772 listen smtp
6773 mode tcp
6774 bind :25
6775 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006776 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006777
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006778 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6779 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6780 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006781
6782 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6783
6784
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006785redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6786redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6787redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006788 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6790 no | yes | yes | yes
6791
6792 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006793 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006794
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006795 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006796 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006797 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6798 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6799 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006800
6801 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6802 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6803 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6804 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6805 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006806 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6807 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6808 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6809 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006810
6811 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6812 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6813 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6814 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6815 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6816 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006817 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006818 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006819 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6820 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6821 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006822
6823 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006824 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6825 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6826 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006827 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006828 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6829 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6830 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6831 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006832
6833 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6834 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6835
6836 - "drop-query"
6837 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6838 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6839 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6840 with a location-type redirect.
6841
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006842 - "append-slash"
6843 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6844 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6845 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6846 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6847
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006848 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6849 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6850 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6851 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6852 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6853 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6854 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6855
6856 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6857 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6858 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6859 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6860 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6861 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6862 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006863
6864 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6865 acl clear dst_port 80
6866 acl secure dst_port 8080
6867 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006868 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006869 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006870 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6871
6872 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006873 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6874 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6875 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006876 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006877
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006878 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6879 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6880 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6881
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006882 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006883 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006884
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006885 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006886 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6887 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6888 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006890 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006891
6892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006893redisp (deprecated)
6894redispatch (deprecated)
6895 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6897 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006898 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006899
6900 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6901 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6902 be able to access the service anymore.
6903
6904 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6905 redistribute them to a working server.
6906
6907 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6908 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6909 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006911 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6912 "option redispatch" instead.
6913
6914 See also : "option redispatch"
6915
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006916
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006917reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006918 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 no | yes | yes | yes
6921 Arguments :
6922 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6923 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006924 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006925
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006926 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6927 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6928
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006929 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6930 the last header of an HTTP request.
6931
6932 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6933 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6934 responses.
6935
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006936 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6937 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6938 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6939
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006940 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6941 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006942
6943
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006944reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6945reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006946 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6948 no | yes | yes | yes
6949 Arguments :
6950 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6951 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6952 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6953 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6954 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6955 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6956 ignores case.
6957
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006958 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6959 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6960
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006961 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6962 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6963 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6964 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006965 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006966
6967 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6968 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6969
6970 Example :
6971 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6972 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6973 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6974
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006975 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6976 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006977
6978
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006979reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6980reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006981 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6983 no | yes | yes | yes
6984 Arguments :
6985 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6986 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6987 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6988 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6989 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6990 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6991
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006992 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6993 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6994
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006995 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6996 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6997 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6998 next servers.
6999
7000 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7001 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7002 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7003
7004 Example :
7005 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7006 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7007 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7008
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007009 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7010 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007011
7012
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007013reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7014reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007015 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7017 no | yes | yes | yes
7018 Arguments :
7019 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7020 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7021 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7022 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7023 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7024 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7025 case.
7026
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007027 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7028 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7029
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007030 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7031 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7032 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7033 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007034 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007035
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007036 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007037 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007038 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007039
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007040 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7041 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7042
7043 Example :
7044 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7045 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7046 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7047
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007048 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7049 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007050
7051
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007052reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7053reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007054 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7056 no | yes | yes | yes
7057 Arguments :
7058 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7059 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7060 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7061 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7062 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7063 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7064 case.
7065
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007066 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7067 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7068
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007069 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7070 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7071 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7072 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7073
7074 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7075 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7076
7077 Example :
7078 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7079 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7080 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7081 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7082
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007083 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7084 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007085
7086
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007087reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7088reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007089 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7091 no | yes | yes | yes
7092 Arguments :
7093 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7094 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7095 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7096 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7097 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7098 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7099
7100 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7101 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7102 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7103 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007104 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007105
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007106 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7107 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7108
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007109 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7110 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7111 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7112
7113 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7114 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7115 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7116 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7117 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7118
7119 Example :
7120 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007121 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007122 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7123 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7124
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007125 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7126 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007127
7128
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007129reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7130reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007131 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7133 no | yes | yes | yes
7134 Arguments :
7135 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7136 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7137 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7138 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7139 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7140 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7141 ignores case.
7142
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007143 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7144 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7145
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007146 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7147 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007148 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7149 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7150 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007151 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7152 not set.
7153
7154 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7155 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7156 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7157 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7158 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7159
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007160 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007161 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7162 # block all others.
7163 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7164 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7165
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007166 # block bad guys
7167 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7168 reqitarpit . if badguys
7169
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007170 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7171 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007172
7173
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007174retries <value>
7175 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7176 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7177 yes | no | yes | yes
7178 Arguments :
7179 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7180 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7181 default value is 3.
7182
7183 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7184 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7185 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7186
7187 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007188 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7189 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007190
7191 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7192 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7193
7194 See also : "option redispatch"
7195
7196
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007197rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007198 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7200 no | yes | yes | yes
7201 Arguments :
7202 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7203 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007204 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007205
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007206 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7207 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7208
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007209 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7210 the last header of an HTTP response.
7211
7212 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7213 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7214 responses.
7215
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007216 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7217 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007218
7219
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007220rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7221rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007222 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7224 no | yes | yes | yes
7225 Arguments :
7226 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7227 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7228 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7229 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7230 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7231 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7232 ignores case.
7233
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007234 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7235 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7236
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007237 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7238 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007239 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007240 client.
7241
7242 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7243 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7244 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7245
7246 Example :
7247 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007248 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007249
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007250 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7251 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007252
7253
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007254rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7255rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007256 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7258 no | yes | yes | yes
7259 Arguments :
7260 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7261 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7262 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7263 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7264 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7265 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7266 ignores case.
7267
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007268 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7269 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7270
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007271 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7272 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7273 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7274 case-sensitive.
7275
7276 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007277 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7278 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7279 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007280
7281 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7282 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7283
7284 Example :
7285 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7286 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7287
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007288 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7289 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007290
7291
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007292rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7293rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007294 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7296 no | yes | yes | yes
7297 Arguments :
7298 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7299 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7300 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7301 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7302 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7303 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7304 ignores case.
7305
7306 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7307 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7308 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7309 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007310 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007311
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007312 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7313 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7314
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007315 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7316 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7317 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7318
7319 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7320 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7321 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7322 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7323 are not case-sensitive.
7324
7325 Example :
7326 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7327 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7328
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007329 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7330 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007331
7332
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007333server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007334 Declare a server in a backend
7335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7336 no | no | yes | yes
7337 Arguments :
7338 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007339 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007340 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007341
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007342 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7343 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7344 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7345 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007346 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7347 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7348 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7349 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7350 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007351 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7352 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7353 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7354 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7355 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7356 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7357 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007358 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007359 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7360 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7361 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007362
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007363 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007364 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7365 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7366 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7367 adding this value to the client's port.
7368
7369 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7370 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007371 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007372
7373 Examples :
7374 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7375 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007376 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007377 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7378 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7379 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007380
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007381 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7382 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7383 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7384 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7385 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7386
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007387 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7388 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007389
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007390server-state-file-name [<file>]
7391 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7392 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7393 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7394 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7395 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7396 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7397
7398 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7399 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7400
7401 global
7402 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7403
7404 backend bk
7405 load-server-state-from-file
7406
7407 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7408 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007409
7410source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007411source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007412source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007413 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7415 yes | no | yes | yes
7416 Arguments :
7417 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7418 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007419
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007420 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007421 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7422 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7423 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7424 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7425 supported prefixes are :
7426 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7427 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7428 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007429 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007430 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7431 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007432
7433 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7434 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007435 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7436 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7437 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007438
7439 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7440 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7441 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7442 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7443 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7444 <addr>.
7445
7446 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7447 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7448 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7449 port.
7450
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007451 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7452 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7453 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7454 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007455 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007456 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7457 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7458 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7459 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7460 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7461 HTTP header.
7462
7463 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7464 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007465 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007466 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7467 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7468 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7469 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7470 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7471 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7472 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7473
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007474 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7475 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7476 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7477 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7478 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7479 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7480
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007481 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7482 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7483 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7484 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7485
7486 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7487 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7488 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7489 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7490 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7491 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7492
7493 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7494 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7495 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7496 there are two methods :
7497
7498 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7499 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7500 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7501 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7502 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7503 of the client ranges may be used.
7504
7505 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7506 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7507 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7508 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7509 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7510 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7511 same session.
7512
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007513 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7514 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7515 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007516 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007517
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007518 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7519
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007520 Examples :
7521 backend private
7522 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7523 source 192.168.1.200
7524
7525 backend transparent_ssl1
7526 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7527 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7528
7529 backend transparent_ssl2
7530 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7531 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7532 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7533
7534 backend transparent_ssl3
7535 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7536 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7537 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7538
7539 backend transparent_smtp
7540 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7541 # with Tproxy version 4.
7542 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7543
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007544 backend transparent_http
7545 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7546 # proxy.
7547 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007549 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007550 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007552
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007553srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7554 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7556 yes | no | yes | yes
7557 Arguments :
7558 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7559 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7560 as explained at the top of this document.
7561
7562 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7563 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7564 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7565 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7566 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7567 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7568 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7569
7570 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7571 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7572 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7573 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7574 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007575 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007576 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007577 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007578
7579 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7580 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7581 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7582 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7583 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7584 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7585
7586 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7587 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7588
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007589 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7590 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007591
7592
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007593stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7594 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007596 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007597
7598 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7599 matched.
7600
7601 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7602 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7603
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007604 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7605 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7606 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7607
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007608 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7609 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7610 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7611 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007612
7613 Example :
7614 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7615 backend stats_localhost
7616 stats enable
7617 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7618
7619 Example :
7620 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7621 backend stats_auth
7622 stats enable
7623 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7624 stats admin if TRUE
7625
7626 Example :
7627 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7628 userlist stats-auth
7629 group admin users admin
7630 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7631 group readonly users haproxy
7632 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7633
7634 backend stats_auth
7635 stats enable
7636 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7637 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7638 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7639 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7640
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007641 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7642 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7643 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007644
7645
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007646stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7647 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007649 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007650 Arguments :
7651 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7652
7653 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7654
7655 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7656 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7657 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7658 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7659 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7660 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7661
7662 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7663 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7664 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007665 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007666
7667 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7668 report using "stats scope".
7669
7670 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7671 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7672 unobvious parameters.
7673
7674 Example :
7675 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7676 backend public_www
7677 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7678 stats enable
7679 stats hide-version
7680 stats scope .
7681 stats uri /admin?stats
7682 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7683 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7684 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7685
7686 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7687 backend private_monitoring
7688 stats enable
7689 stats uri /admin?stats
7690 stats refresh 5s
7691
7692 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7693
7694
7695stats enable
7696 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007698 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007699 Arguments : none
7700
7701 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7702 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7703 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7704 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7705 - stats auth : no authentication
7706 - stats scope : no restriction
7707
7708 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7709 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7710 unobvious parameters.
7711
7712 Example :
7713 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7714 backend public_www
7715 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7716 stats enable
7717 stats hide-version
7718 stats scope .
7719 stats uri /admin?stats
7720 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7721 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7722 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7723
7724 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7725 backend private_monitoring
7726 stats enable
7727 stats uri /admin?stats
7728 stats refresh 5s
7729
7730 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7731
7732
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007733stats hide-version
7734 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007736 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007737 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007738
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007739 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7740 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7741 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7742 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7743 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7744 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007746 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7747 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7748 unobvious parameters.
7749
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007750 Example :
7751 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7752 backend public_www
7753 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007754 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007755 stats hide-version
7756 stats scope .
7757 stats uri /admin?stats
7758 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7759 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7760 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007761
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007762 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7763 backend private_monitoring
7764 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007765 stats uri /admin?stats
7766 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007767
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007768 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007769
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007770
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007771stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7772 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7773 Access control for statistics
7774
7775 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7776 no | no | yes | yes
7777
7778 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7779 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7780 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7781 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7782 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7783 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7784
7785 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7786 instance.
7787
7788 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7789 about ACL usage.
7790
7791
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007792stats realm <realm>
7793 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007795 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007796 Arguments :
7797 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7798 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7799 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7800
7801 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7802 using a backslash ('\').
7803
7804 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7805 only related to authentication.
7806
7807 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7808 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7809 unobvious parameters.
7810
7811 Example :
7812 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7813 backend public_www
7814 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7815 stats enable
7816 stats hide-version
7817 stats scope .
7818 stats uri /admin?stats
7819 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7820 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7821 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7822
7823 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7824 backend private_monitoring
7825 stats enable
7826 stats uri /admin?stats
7827 stats refresh 5s
7828
7829 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7830
7831
7832stats refresh <delay>
7833 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007835 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007836 Arguments :
7837 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7838 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7839 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7840 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7841 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7842 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7843
7844 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7845 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7846 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7847 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7848
7849 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7850 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7851 unobvious parameters.
7852
7853 Example :
7854 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7855 backend public_www
7856 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7857 stats enable
7858 stats hide-version
7859 stats scope .
7860 stats uri /admin?stats
7861 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7862 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7863 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7864
7865 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7866 backend private_monitoring
7867 stats enable
7868 stats uri /admin?stats
7869 stats refresh 5s
7870
7871 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7872
7873
7874stats scope { <name> | "." }
7875 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007877 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007878 Arguments :
7879 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7880 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7881 section in which the statement appears.
7882
7883 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7884 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7885 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7886 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7887 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7888 exists.
7889
7890 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7891 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7892 unobvious parameters.
7893
7894 Example :
7895 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7896 backend public_www
7897 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7898 stats enable
7899 stats hide-version
7900 stats scope .
7901 stats uri /admin?stats
7902 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7903 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7904 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7905
7906 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7907 backend private_monitoring
7908 stats enable
7909 stats uri /admin?stats
7910 stats refresh 5s
7911
7912 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7913
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007914
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007915stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007916 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007918 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007919
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007920 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007921 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7922
7923 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7924 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7925
7926 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7927 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007928 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007929
7930 Example :
7931 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7932 backend private_monitoring
7933 stats enable
7934 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7935 stats uri /admin?stats
7936 stats refresh 5s
7937
7938 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7939 global section.
7940
7941
7942stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007943 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7945 yes | yes | yes | yes
7946 Arguments : none
7947
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007948 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007949 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7950 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7951 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7952 - IP (socket, server)
7953 - cookie (backend, server)
7954
7955 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7956 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007957 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007958
7959 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7960
7961
7962stats show-node [ <name> ]
7963 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007965 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007966 Arguments:
7967 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7968 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7969
7970 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7971 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007972 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007973
7974 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7975 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7976 unobvious parameters.
7977
7978 Example:
7979 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7980 backend private_monitoring
7981 stats enable
7982 stats show-node Europe-1
7983 stats uri /admin?stats
7984 stats refresh 5s
7985
7986 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7987 section.
7988
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007989
7990stats uri <prefix>
7991 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007993 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007994 Arguments :
7995 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7996 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7997 query string.
7998
7999 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8000 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8001 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8002 possible to reach it in the application.
8003
8004 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008005 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008006 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8007 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8008 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8009 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8010
8011 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8012 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8013 an address or a port to statistics only.
8014
8015 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8016 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8017 unobvious parameters.
8018
8019 Example :
8020 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8021 backend public_www
8022 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8023 stats enable
8024 stats hide-version
8025 stats scope .
8026 stats uri /admin?stats
8027 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8028 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8029 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8030
8031 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8032 backend private_monitoring
8033 stats enable
8034 stats uri /admin?stats
8035 stats refresh 5s
8036
8037 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8038
8039
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008040stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8041 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008043 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008044
8045 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008046 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008047 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8048 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8049 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8050
8051 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8052 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8053 the "stick-table" statement.
8054
8055 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8056 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8057 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8058 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8059 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8060
8061 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8062 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8063 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8064 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8065 transformation rules.
8066
8067 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8068 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8069 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8070 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8071 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8072 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8073 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8074
8075 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8076 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8077 ACL based conditions.
8078
8079 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8080 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8081 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8082 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8083
8084 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8085 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8086 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8087 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8088
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008089 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8090 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8091 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8092
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008093 Example :
8094 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8095 # last 30 minutes
8096 backend pop
8097 mode tcp
8098 balance roundrobin
8099 stick store-request src
8100 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8101 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8102 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8103
8104 backend smtp
8105 mode tcp
8106 balance roundrobin
8107 stick match src table pop
8108 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8109 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8110
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008111 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008112 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008113
8114
8115stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8116 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8118 no | no | yes | yes
8119
8120 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8121 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8122 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8123 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8124
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008125 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8126 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8127 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8128
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008129 Examples :
8130 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008131 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008132
8133 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8134 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8135 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8136
8137
8138 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8139 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8140 backend http
8141 mode http
8142 balance roundrobin
8143 stick on src table https
8144 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8145 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8146 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8147
8148 backend https
8149 mode tcp
8150 balance roundrobin
8151 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8152 stick on src
8153 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8154 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8155
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008156 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008157
8158
8159stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8160 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8162 no | no | yes | yes
8163
8164 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008165 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008166 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8167 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8168 server is selected.
8169
8170 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8171 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8172 the "stick-table" statement.
8173
8174 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8175 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8176 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8177 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8178 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8179 address.
8180
8181 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8182 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8183 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8184 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8185 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8186 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8187 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8188 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8189 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8190 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8191
8192 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8193 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8194 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8195 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8196 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8197 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8198 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8199
8200 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8201 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8202 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8203 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8204
8205 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8206 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8207 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8208 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8209 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8210 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008211 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8212 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8213 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8214 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8215 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8216 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008217
8218 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8219 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8220 the request.
8221
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008222 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8223 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8224 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8225
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008226 Example :
8227 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8228 # last 30 minutes
8229 backend pop
8230 mode tcp
8231 balance roundrobin
8232 stick store-request src
8233 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8234 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8235 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8236
8237 backend smtp
8238 mode tcp
8239 balance roundrobin
8240 stick match src table pop
8241 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8242 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8243
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008244 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008245 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008246
8247
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008248stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008249 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8250 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008251 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008253 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008254
8255 Arguments :
8256 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8257 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8258 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8259 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8260
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008261 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8262 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8263 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8264 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8265
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008266 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8267 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8268 instance.
8269
8270 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8271 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8272 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8273 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8274 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8275 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008276 to 32 characters.
8277
8278 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8279 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8280 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008281 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008282 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8283 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008284
8285 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008286 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8287 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008288 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8289 increase.
8290
8291 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008292 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8293 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8294 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008295
8296 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8297 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8298 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8299 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8300 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8301 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8302 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8303 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8304 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8305 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8306 parameter (see below).
8307
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008308 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8309 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8310 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8311 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8312 soft restart.
8313
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008314 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8315 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008316
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008317 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8318 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8319 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8320 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8321 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008322 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008323 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8324 if not expiration delay is specified.
8325
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008326 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8327 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8328 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8329 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008330 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8331 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8332 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8333 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8334 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8335 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8336 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8337 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8338 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8339 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8340 types and their arguments.
8341
8342 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8343 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8344 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8345 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8346
8347 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8348 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8349 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8350 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8351
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008352 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8353 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8354 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8355 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8356 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8357 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8358
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008359 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8360 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8361 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8362 they were received.
8363
8364 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8365 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8366 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8367 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8368 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8369
8370 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8371 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8372 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8373 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8374 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8375
8376 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8377 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8378 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8379
8380 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8381 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8382 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8383 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8384 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8385
8386 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8387 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8388 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8389 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8390 the client side.
8391
8392 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8393 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8394 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8395 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8396 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8397 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8398 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8399
8400 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8401 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8402 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8403 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8404 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8405 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8406 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8407
8408 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8409 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8410 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8411 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8412 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8413 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8414
8415 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8416 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8417 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8418 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8419
8420 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8421 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8422 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8423 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8424 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8425 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8426 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8427 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8428 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8429 recommended for better fairness.
8430
8431 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8432 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8433 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8434 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8435
8436 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8437 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8438 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8439 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8440 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8441 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8442 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8443 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8444 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8445 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008446
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008447 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8448 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008449 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8450 reference it.
8451
8452 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8453 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008454 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8455 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8456 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008457
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008458 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8459 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8460 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8461 something that can be ignored.
8462
8463 Example:
8464 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8465 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8466 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8467 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8468
8469 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008470 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008471
8472
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008473stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008474 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8476 no | no | yes | yes
8477
8478 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008479 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008480 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8481 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8482 server is selected.
8483
8484 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8485 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8486 the "stick-table" statement.
8487
8488 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8489 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8490 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8491 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8492
8493 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8494 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8495 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8496 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8497 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8498 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008499 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008500 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8501 rules.
8502
8503 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8504 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8505 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8506 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8507 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8508 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8509 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8510
8511 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8512 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8513 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8514 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8515
8516 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8517 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8518 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8519 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8520 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8521 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008522 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8523 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8524 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8525 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8526 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8527 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8528 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8529 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8530 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008531
8532 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8533
8534 Example :
8535 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8536 backend https
8537 mode tcp
8538 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008539 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008540 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008541
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008542 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8543 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8544
8545 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8546 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8547 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8548
8549 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8550 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008551
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008552 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8553 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8554 # at offset 44.
8555
8556 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8557 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8558
8559 # Learn on response if server hello.
8560 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008561
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008562 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8563 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8564
8565 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8566 extraction.
8567
8568
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008569tcp-check connect [params*]
8570 Opens a new connection
8571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8572 no | no | yes | yes
8573
8574 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8575 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8576 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8577
8578 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8579 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8580 of the sequence.
8581
8582 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8583 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8584 do.
8585
8586 Parameters :
8587 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8588 use the TCP connection.
8589
8590 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8591 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8592 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8593
8594 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8595
8596 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8597
8598 Examples:
8599 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8600 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8601 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8602 option tcp-check
8603 tcp-check connect
8604 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8605 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8606 tcp-check send \r\n
8607 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8608 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8609 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8610 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8611 tcp-check send \r\n
8612 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8613 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8614
8615 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8616 option tcp-check
8617 tcp-check connect port 110
8618 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8619 tcp-check connect port 143
8620 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8621 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8622
8623 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8624
8625
8626tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8627 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8628 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8629 no | no | yes | yes
8630
8631 Arguments :
8632 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8633 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8634 binary.
8635 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8636 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8637 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8638
8639 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8640 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8641 with the usual backslash ('\').
8642 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8643 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8644 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8645 used upper or lower case.
8646
8647
8648 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8649
8650 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8651 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8652 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8653 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8654 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8655 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8656 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8657 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8658
8659 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8660 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8661 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8662 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8663 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8664 expression.
8665
8666 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8667 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8668 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8669 this exact hexadecimal string.
8670 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8671
8672 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8673 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8674 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8675 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8676 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8677 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8678 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8679 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8680 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8681 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8682 the null character.
8683
8684 Examples :
8685 # perform a POP check
8686 option tcp-check
8687 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8688
8689 # perform an IMAP check
8690 option tcp-check
8691 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8692
8693 # look for the redis master server
8694 option tcp-check
8695 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008696 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008697 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8698 tcp-check expect string role:master
8699 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8700 tcp-check expect string +OK
8701
8702
8703 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8704 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8705
8706
8707tcp-check send <data>
8708 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8709 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8710 no | no | yes | yes
8711
8712 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8713 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8714
8715 Examples :
8716 # look for the redis master server
8717 option tcp-check
8718 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8719 tcp-check expect string role:master
8720
8721 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8722 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8723
8724
8725tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8726 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8727 tcp health check
8728 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8729 no | no | yes | yes
8730
8731 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8732 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8733 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8734 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8735 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8736 hexadecimal string.
8737 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8738
8739 Examples :
8740 # redis check in binary
8741 option tcp-check
8742 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8743 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8744
8745
8746 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8747 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8748
8749
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008750tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8751 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8753 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008754 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008755 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8756 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008757
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008758 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008759
8760 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8761 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008762 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8763 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8764 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8765 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8766 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8767 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008768
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008769 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8770 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8771 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8772 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008773
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008774 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008775 - accept :
8776 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8777 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8778 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008779
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008780 - reject :
8781 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8782 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8783 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8784 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8785 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8786 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8787 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8788 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8789 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8790 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8791 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008792 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008793
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008794 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8795 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8796 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8797 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8798 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8799 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8800 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8801 hosts.
8802
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008803 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8804 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8805 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8806 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8807 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8808 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8809 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8810 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8811
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008812 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8813 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8814 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8815 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8816 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8817 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8818 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8819 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8820 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008821 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8822 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008823
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008824 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008825 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008826 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008827 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008828 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8829 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008830 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008831 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8832 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8833 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8834 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8835 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008836
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008837 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008838 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008839 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008840 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8841 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8842 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8843 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008844
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008845 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8846 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8847 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8848 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008849
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008850 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8851 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8852 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8853 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8854 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008855 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8856 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8857 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8858 layer7 information is extracted.
8859
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008860 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8861 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8862 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8863 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8864 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008865
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008866 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8867 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8868 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8869 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8870
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008871 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8872 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8873 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8874 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8875 continues.
8876
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008877 - set-src <expr> :
8878 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8879 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8880 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8881 set-src"
8882
8883 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8884 followed by some converters.
8885
8886 Example:
8887
8888 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8889
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008890 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8891 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008892
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008893 - set-src-port <expr> :
8894 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8895 expression.
8896
8897 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8898 followed by some converters.
8899
8900 Example:
8901
8902 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8903
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008904 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
8905 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
8906 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008907
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008908 - set-dst <expr> :
8909 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8910 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8911 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8912 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8913 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8914
8915 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8916 followed by some converters.
8917
8918 Example:
8919
8920 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8921 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8922
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008923 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
8924 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
8925
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008926 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8927 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8928 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8929 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8930
8931
8932 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8933 followed by some converters.
8934
8935 Example:
8936
8937 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8938
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008939 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
8940 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
8941 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
8942
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008943 - "silent-drop" :
8944 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8945 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8946 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8947 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8948 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8949 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8950 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8951 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8952 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8953 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8954 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8955 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8956 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8957 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8958 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8959 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8960
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008961 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8962 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8963 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008964
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008965 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8966 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8967 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008968
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008969 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008970 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008971 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008973 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8974 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8975 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008977 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008978 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8979 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008980
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008981 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8982
8983 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8984
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008985 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8986
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008987 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008988
8989
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008990tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8991 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008993 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008994 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008995 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8996 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008997
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008998 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008999
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009000 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9001 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9002 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9003 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9004 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009005
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009006 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9007 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9008 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9009 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009010 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9011 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9012 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9013 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9014 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9015 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009016 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009017 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009018
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009019 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9020 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9021 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9022 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009023
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009024 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009025 - accept : the request is accepted
9026 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9027 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009028 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009029 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009030 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009031 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009032 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009033
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009034 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9035 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009036
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009037 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9038 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9039 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9040 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9041 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9042 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009043
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009044 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009045 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9046 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009048 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009049 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9050 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9051 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9052 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009053 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9054 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9055 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009056
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009057 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009058 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9059 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9060 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009061
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009062 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009063 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9064 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009065
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009066 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9067 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9068 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9069 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009070 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009071 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009072 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009073 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9074 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009075 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009076 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9077 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009078
9079 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9080 followed by some converters.
9081
9082 Example:
9083
9084 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9085
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009086 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009087 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9088 # and reject everything else.
9089 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9090 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009091 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009092 tcp-request content reject
9093
9094 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009095 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9096 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9097 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009098 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009099
9100 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9101 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9102 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009103 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009104 tcp-request content reject
9105
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009106 Example:
9107 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
9108 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009109 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009110
9111 Example:
9112 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9113 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009114 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009115
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009116 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
9117 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
9118
9119 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009120 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009121 # protecting all our sites
9122 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009123 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9124 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009125 ...
9126 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9127
9128 backend http_dynamic
9129 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009130 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009131 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009132 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
9133 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9134 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009135 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009137 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009138
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009139 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9140 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009141
9142
9143tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9144 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009146 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009147 Arguments :
9148 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9150 as explained at the top of this document.
9151
9152 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9153 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9154 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9155 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9156 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9157
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009158 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9159 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9160 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9161 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9162
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009163 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9164 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009165 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009166 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009167 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9168 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9169 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9170 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009171
9172 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9173 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9174 it pass through unaffected.
9175
9176 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9177 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9178 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009179 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009180 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9181 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009182 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9183 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9184 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009185
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009186 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009187 "timeout client".
9188
9189
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009190tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9191 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9193 no | no | yes | yes
9194 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009195 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9196 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009197
9198 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9199
9200 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9201 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9202 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009203 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9204 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009205
9206 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9207
9208 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9209 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9210 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9211 inserted.
9212
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009213 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009214 - accept :
9215 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9216 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9217 the rules evaluation.
9218
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009219 - close :
9220 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9221 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9222 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9223 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9224 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9225 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009226 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009227 protocols.
9228
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009229 - reject :
9230 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9231 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009232 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009233
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009234 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9235 Sets a variable.
9236
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009237 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9238 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9239 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9240 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9241
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009242 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9243 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9244 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9245 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9246 continues.
9247
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009248 - "silent-drop" :
9249 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9250 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9251 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9252 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9253 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9254 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9255 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9256 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9257 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9258 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9259 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9260 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9261 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9262 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9263 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9264 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9265
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009266 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9267 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9268 for changing the default action to a reject.
9269
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009270 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9271 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9272 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9273 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009274 period.
9275
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009276 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9277 declared inline.
9278
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009279 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9280 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9281 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9282 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009283 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009284 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009285 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009286 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9287 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009288 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009289 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9290 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009291
9292 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9293 followed by some converters.
9294
9295 Example:
9296
9297 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9298
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009299 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9300
9301 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9302
9303
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009304tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9305 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9307 no | yes | yes | no
9308 Arguments :
9309 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9310 below.
9311
9312 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9313
9314 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9315 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9316 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9317 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9318 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9319 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9320 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9321 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9322 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9323 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9324 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9325 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9326 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9327 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9328 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9329 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9330 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9331 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9332 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9333 instead.
9334
9335 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9336 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9337 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9338 rules which may be inserted.
9339
9340 Several types of actions are supported :
9341 - accept : the request is accepted
9342 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9343 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9344 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9345 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9346 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9347 - silent-drop
9348
9349 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9350 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9351 sections for a complete description.
9352
9353 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9354 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9355 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9356
9357 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9358 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9359 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9360 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9361 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9362
9363 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9364 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9365
9366 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9367 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9368 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9369
9370 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9371 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9372 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9373
9374 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9375 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9376 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9377
9378 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9379 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9380 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9381
9382 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9383
9384 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9385
9386
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009387tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9388 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9390 no | no | yes | yes
9391 Arguments :
9392 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9393 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9394 as explained at the top of this document.
9395
9396 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9397
9398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009399timeout check <timeout>
9400 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9401 established.
9402
9403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9404 yes | no | yes | yes
9405 Arguments:
9406 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9407 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9408 as explained at the top of this document.
9409
9410 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9411 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9412 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9413 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009414 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9415 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9416 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009417
9418 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9419 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9420
9421 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9422 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009423 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009424
9425 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9426 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9427 forget about it.
9428
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009429 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9430 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009431
9432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009433timeout client <timeout>
9434timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9435 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9437 yes | yes | yes | no
9438 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009439 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009440 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9441 as explained at the top of this document.
9442
9443 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9444 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9445 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009446 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9447 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9448 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9449 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009450 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9451 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9452 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009453 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009454 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009455 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9456 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009457 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9458 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009459
9460 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9461 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9462 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9463 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9464 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9465 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9466
9467 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9468 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9469 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9470
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009471 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9472 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009473
9474
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009475timeout client-fin <timeout>
9476 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9478 yes | yes | yes | no
9479 Arguments :
9480 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9481 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9482 as explained at the top of this document.
9483
9484 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9485 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9486 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9487 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9488 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9489 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9490 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9491 down in one direction.
9492
9493 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9494 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9495 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9496
9497 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9498
9499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009500timeout connect <timeout>
9501timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9502 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9504 yes | no | yes | yes
9505 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009506 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009507 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9508 as explained at the top of this document.
9509
9510 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009511 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009512 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009513 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009514 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9515 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009516
9517 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9518 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9519 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9520 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9521 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9522 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9523
9524 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9525 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9526 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9527
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009528 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9529 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009530
9531
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009532timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9533 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9535 yes | yes | yes | yes
9536 Arguments :
9537 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9538 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9539 as explained at the top of this document.
9540
9541 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9542 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9543 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9544 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9545 once the request has started to present itself.
9546
9547 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9548 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9549 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9550 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9551 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9552
9553 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9554 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9555 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9556 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9557
9558 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9559 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9560 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9561 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9562 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009563 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009564
9565 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9566 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9567 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9568 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9569
9570 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9571
9572
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009573timeout http-request <timeout>
9574 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009576 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009577 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009578 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009579 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9580 as explained at the top of this document.
9581
9582 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9583 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9584 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9585 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9586 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9587 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9588 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009589 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9590 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9591 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9592 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9593 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009594 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9595 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009596
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009597 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9598 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9599 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9600 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9601 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009602 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009603
9604 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9605 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9606 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9607 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9608 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9609
9610 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009611 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9612 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9613 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009614
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009615 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009616 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009617
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009618
9619timeout queue <timeout>
9620 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9622 yes | no | yes | yes
9623 Arguments :
9624 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9625 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9626 as explained at the top of this document.
9627
9628 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9629 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9630 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9631 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9632 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9633
9634 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9635 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9636 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9637 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9638
9639 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9640
9641
9642timeout server <timeout>
9643timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9644 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9646 yes | no | yes | yes
9647 Arguments :
9648 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9649 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9650 as explained at the top of this document.
9651
9652 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9653 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9654 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9655 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9656 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9657 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9658 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9659
9660 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9661 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9662 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9663 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9664 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009665 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009666 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009667 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9668 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9669 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9670 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009671
9672 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9673 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9674 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9675 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9676 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9677 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9678
9679 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9680 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9681 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9682
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009683 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009684
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009685
9686timeout server-fin <timeout>
9687 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9689 yes | no | yes | yes
9690 Arguments :
9691 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9692 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9693 as explained at the top of this document.
9694
9695 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9696 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9697 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9698 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9699 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9700 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9701 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9702 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9703 situations, it should not be needed.
9704
9705 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9706 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9707 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9708
9709 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9710
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009711
9712timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009713 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9715 yes | yes | yes | yes
9716 Arguments :
9717 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9718 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9719 as explained at the top of this document.
9720
9721 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9722 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9723 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9724
9725 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9726 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9727 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9728 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009729 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009730
9731 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9732
9733
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009734timeout tunnel <timeout>
9735 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9737 yes | no | yes | yes
9738 Arguments :
9739 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9740 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9741 as explained at the top of this document.
9742
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009743 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009744 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9745 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9746 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9747 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9748 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9749 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9750 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9751 specified.
9752
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009753 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9754 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9755 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9756 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9757 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9758 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9759 state.
9760
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009761 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9762 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9763 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9764 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9765 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9766
9767 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9768 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9769 forget about it.
9770
9771 Example :
9772 defaults http
9773 option http-server-close
9774 timeout connect 5s
9775 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009776 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009777 timeout server 30s
9778 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9779
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009780 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009781
9782
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009783transparent (deprecated)
9784 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009786 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009787 Arguments : none
9788
9789 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9790 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9791 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9792 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9793 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9794 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9795 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9796 appropriate server.
9797
9798 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9799
9800 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9801 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9802
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009803 See also: "option transparent"
9804
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009805unique-id-format <string>
9806 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9808 yes | yes | yes | no
9809 Arguments :
9810 <string> is a log-format string.
9811
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009812 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9813 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9814 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9815 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009816
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009817 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9818 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9819 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9820 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9821 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9822 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9823 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9824 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009825
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009826 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9827 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009828
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009829 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009830
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009831 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009832
9833 will generate:
9834
9835 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9836
9837 See also: "unique-id-header"
9838
9839unique-id-header <name>
9840 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9842 yes | yes | yes | no
9843 Arguments :
9844 <name> is the name of the header.
9845
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009846 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9847 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009848
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009849 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009850
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009851 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009852 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9853
9854 will generate:
9855
9856 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9857
9858 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009859
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009860use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009861 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9863 no | yes | yes | no
9864 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009865 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9866 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009867
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009868 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9869 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009870
9871 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9872 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9873 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009874 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9875 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9876 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9877 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009878
9879 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9880 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9881 assign the backend.
9882
9883 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9884 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9885 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9886 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9887 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9888 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9889
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009890 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009891 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009892 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9893 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9894 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9895
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009896 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9897 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9898 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9899 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9900 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9901 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9902 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9903 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9904 cannot be forced from the request.
9905
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009906 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009907 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9908 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9909
9910 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9911 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009912
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009913
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009914use-server <server> if <condition>
9915use-server <server> unless <condition>
9916 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9918 no | no | yes | yes
9919 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009920 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009921
9922 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9923
9924 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9925 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9926 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9927
9928 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9929 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9930 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9931 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9932 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9933 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9934 matches will assign the server.
9935
9936 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9937 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9938 with the next rules until one matches.
9939
9940 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9941 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9942 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9943 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9944
9945 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9946 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9947 stripped.
9948
9949 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9950 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9951 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9952 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9953
9954 Example :
9955 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9956 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9957 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9958 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9959 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9960 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9961 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9962 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9963 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9964
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009965 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009966
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009967
99685. Bind and Server options
9969--------------------------
9970
9971The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9972depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9973settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9974written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9975described in this section.
9976
9977
99785.1. Bind options
9979-----------------
9980
9981The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9982as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9983no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9984parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9985while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9986provided immediately after the setting name.
9987
9988The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9989
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009990accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
9991 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
9992 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
9993 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
9994 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
9995 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
9996 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
9997 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
9998 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
9999 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010000 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10001 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10002 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010003
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010004accept-proxy
10005 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010006 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10007 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010008 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10009 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10010 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10011 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10012 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10013 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10014 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010015 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10016 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010017
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010018alpn <protocols>
10019 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10020 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10021 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10022 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10023 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10024 initial NPN extension.
10025
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010026backlog <backlog>
10027 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10028 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10029
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010030ecdhe <named curve>
10031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010032 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10033 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010034
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010035ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010036 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10037 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10038 client's certificate.
10039
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010040ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10041 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10042 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10043 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10044 error is ignored.
10045
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010046ca-sign-file <cafile>
10047 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10048 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10049 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10050 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10051 'generate-certificates' for details.
10052
10053ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
10054 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10055 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10056 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10057 'generate-certificates' for details.
10058
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010059ciphers <ciphers>
10060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10061 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010062 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010063 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10064 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10065
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010066crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010067 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10068 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10069 to verify client's certificate.
10070
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010071crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010072 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10073 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10074 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10075 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10076 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10077 file.
10078
10079 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10080 are loaded.
10081
10082 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010083 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010084 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10085 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10086 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10087 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10088 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10089 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10090 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010091
10092 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10093 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10094 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10095 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010096 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10097 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010098
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010099 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010100
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010101 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10102 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010103 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010104 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10105 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10106 clients).
10107
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010108 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10109 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10110 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10111 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10112 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10113 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10114 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10115 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10116 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10117 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10118 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10119 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10120 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10121
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010122 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10123 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10124 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10125 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10126 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10127
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010128 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10129 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10130 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10131 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010132
10133 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10134 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10135 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10136 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10137 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10138 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10139 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10140 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10141 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10142
10143 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10144
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010145 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010146 a cert bundle.
10147
10148 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10149 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10150 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10151 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10152 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10153 provide multi-cert support.
10154
10155 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10156
10157 Filename | CN | SAN
10158 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10159 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010160 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010161 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10162 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10163
10164 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10165 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10166 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10167 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
10168 suites.
10169
10170 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10171 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10172
10173 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10174 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10175 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10176
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010177crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10179 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010180 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010181 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010182
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010183crt-list <file>
10184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010185 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
10186 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010187
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010188 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010189
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010190 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10191 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10192 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10193 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10194 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10195 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10196 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10197 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010198
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010199 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010200 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
10201 all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010202
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010203defer-accept
10204 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10205 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10206 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10207 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10208 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10209 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10210 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10211 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10212 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10213 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10214 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10215
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010216force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010217 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010218 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010219 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10220 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010221
10222force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010223 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010224 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10225 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010226
10227force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010228 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010229 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10230 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010231
10232force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010233 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010234 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10235 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010236
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010237generate-certificates
10238 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10239 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10240 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10241 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10242 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10243 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10244 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10245 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10246 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10247 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10248 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10249
10250 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10251 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10252 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10253 certificate is used many times.
10254
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010255gid <gid>
10256 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10257 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10258 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10259 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10260 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10261
10262group <group>
10263 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10264 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10265 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10266 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10267 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10268
10269id <id>
10270 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10271 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10272 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10273 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10274
10275interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010276 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10277 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10278 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10279 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10280 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10281 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10282 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010283
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010284level <level>
10285 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10286 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10287 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10288 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10289 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10290 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10291 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10292 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10293 counters).
10294 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10295 all counters).
10296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010297maxconn <maxconn>
10298 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10299 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10300 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10301 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10302 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10303 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10304 eat all memory.
10305
10306mode <mode>
10307 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10308 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10309 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10310 UNIX sockets.
10311
10312mss <maxseg>
10313 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10314 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10315 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10316 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10317 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10318 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10319 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10320 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10321 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10322 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10323 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10324
10325name <name>
10326 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10327 page.
10328
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010329namespace <name>
10330 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10331 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10332 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10333 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10334
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010335nice <nice>
10336 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10337 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10338 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10339 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10340 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10341 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10342 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10343 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10344 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10345 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10346 one for an RDP socket.
10347
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010348no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010350 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010351 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010352 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10353 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010354 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010355
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010356no-tls-tickets
10357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10358 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10359 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010360 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10361 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010362
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010363no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010365 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010366 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010367 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10368 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10369 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010370
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010371no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010372 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010373 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010374 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010375 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10376 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10377 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010378
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010379no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010380 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010381 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010382 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010383 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10384 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10385 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010386
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010387npn <protocols>
10388 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10389 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10390 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10391 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010392 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10393 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010394
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010395process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10396 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10397 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10398 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10399 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10400 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10401 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10402 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010403 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10404 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10405 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10406 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10407 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10408 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10409 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010410
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010411ssl
10412 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010413 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010414 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10415 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10416 to deciphered contents.
10417
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010418strict-sni
10419 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10420 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10421 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10422 See the "crt" option for more information.
10423
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010424tcp-ut <delay>
10425 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10426 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10427 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10428 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10429 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10430 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10431 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10432 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10433 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10434 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10435 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10436
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010437tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010438 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010439 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10440 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10441 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10442 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10443 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10444 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10445 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010446 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10447 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10448 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010449
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010450tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10451 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10452 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10453 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10454 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10455 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10456 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10457 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10458 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10459 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10460 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10461
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010462transparent
10463 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10464 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10465 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10466 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10467 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10468 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10469 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10470 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10471 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10472 so check for support with your vendor.
10473
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010474v4v6
10475 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10476 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10477 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10478 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010479 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010480
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010481v6only
10482 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10483 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10484 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010485 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10486 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010487
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010488uid <uid>
10489 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10490 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10491 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10492 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10493 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10494
10495user <user>
10496 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10497 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10498 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10499 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10500 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10501
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010502verify [none|optional|required]
10503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10504 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10505 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10506 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10507 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010508 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10509 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10510 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10511 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010512
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200105135.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010514------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010516The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10517which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10518arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10519settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10520after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10521Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10522address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010524 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010525 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010526
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010527The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010528
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010529addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010530 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010531 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10532 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10533 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10534 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10535 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010537 Supported in default-server: No
10538
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010539agent-check
10540 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010541 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10542 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10543 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10544 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010545
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010546 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010547 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010548 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10549 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10550 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010551
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010552 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10553 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10554 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10555 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10556 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10557
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010558 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10559 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010560
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010561 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10562 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10563 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010564
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010565 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10566 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10567 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010568
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010569 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10570 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10571 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10572 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10573 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10574 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10575 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010576
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010577 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10578 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010579
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010580 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10581 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10582 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10583 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10584 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10585 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10586 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10587 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10588 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010589
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010590 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10591 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010592 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10593 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10594 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010595 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010596
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010597 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10598 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010599
10600 Supported in default-server: No
10601
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010602agent-send <string>
10603 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10604 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10605 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10606 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10607 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10608
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010609agent-inter <delay>
10610 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10611 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10612
10613 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10614 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10615 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10616 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10617 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10618 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10619 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10620 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10621 of backends use the same servers.
10622
10623 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10624
10625 Supported in default-server: Yes
10626
10627agent-port <port>
10628 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10629
10630 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10631
10632 Supported in default-server: Yes
10633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010634backup
10635 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10636 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10637 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10638 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10639 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10640 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010641
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010642 Supported in default-server: No
10643
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010644ca-file <cafile>
10645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10646 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10647 server's certificate.
10648
10649 Supported in default-server: No
10650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010651check
10652 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010653 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10654 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10655 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10656 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10657 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10658 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10659 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010660 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10661 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10662 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010664 Supported in default-server: No
10665
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010666check-send-proxy
10667 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10668 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10669 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10670 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10671 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10672 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10673 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10674
10675 Supported in default-server: No
10676
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010677check-ssl
10678 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10679 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10680 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10681 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010682 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010683 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10684 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10685 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10686 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10687
10688 Supported in default-server: No
10689
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010690ciphers <ciphers>
10691 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010692 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010693 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10694 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10695 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10696 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10697 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10698 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10699
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010700 Supported in default-server: No
10701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010702cookie <value>
10703 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10704 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10705 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10706 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10707 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10708 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10709 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010711 Supported in default-server: No
10712
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010713crl-file <crlfile>
10714 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10715 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10716 to verify server's certificate.
10717
10718 Supported in default-server: No
10719
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010720crt <cert>
10721 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10722 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10723 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10724 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10725 certificate request.
10726
10727 Supported in default-server: No
10728
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010729disabled
10730 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10731 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10732 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10733 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10734 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10735
10736 Supported in default-server: No
10737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010738error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010739 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10740 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10741 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010743 Supported in default-server: Yes
10744
10745 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010747fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010748 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10749 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10750 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010752 Supported in default-server: Yes
10753
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010754force-sslv3
10755 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10756 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010757 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10758 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010759
10760 Supported in default-server: No
10761
10762force-tlsv10
10763 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010764 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10765 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010766
10767 Supported in default-server: No
10768
10769force-tlsv11
10770 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010771 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10772 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010773
10774 Supported in default-server: No
10775
10776force-tlsv12
10777 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010778 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10779 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010780
10781 Supported in default-server: No
10782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010783id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010784 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10785 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10786 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010788 Supported in default-server: No
10789
10790inter <delay>
10791fastinter <delay>
10792downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010793 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10794 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10795 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10796 between checks depending on the server state :
10797
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010798 Server state | Interval used
10799 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10800 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10801 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10802 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10803 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10804 or yet unchecked. |
10805 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10806 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10807 | "inter" otherwise.
10808 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010810 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10811 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10812 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10813 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010814 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10815 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10816 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10817 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10818 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010820 Supported in default-server: Yes
10821
10822maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010823 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10824 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10825 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10826 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10827 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10828 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10829 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10830 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10831
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010832 Supported in default-server: Yes
10833
10834maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010835 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10836 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10837 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10838 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10839 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10840 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10841 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010843 Supported in default-server: Yes
10844
10845minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010846 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10847 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10848 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10849 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10850 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10851 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010852 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010853 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010855 Supported in default-server: Yes
10856
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010857namespace <name>
10858 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10859 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10860 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10861 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10862
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010863no-ssl-reuse
10864 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10865 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10866 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10867 and for paranoid users.
10868
10869 Supported in default-server: No
10870
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010871no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010872 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10873 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010874 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010875
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010876 Supported in default-server: No
10877
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010878no-tls-tickets
10879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10880 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10881 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010882 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10883 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010884
10885 Supported in default-server: No
10886
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010887no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010888 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010889 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10890 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010891 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10892 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10893 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010894
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010895 Supported in default-server: No
10896
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010897no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010898 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010899 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10900 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010901 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10902 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10903 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010904
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010905 Supported in default-server: No
10906
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010907no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010908 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010909 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10910 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010911 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10912 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10913 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010914
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010915 Supported in default-server: No
10916
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010917non-stick
10918 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10919 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10920 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10921
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010922 Supported in default-server: No
10923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010924observe <mode>
10925 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10926 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10927 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10928 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10929 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10930 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010931 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010933 Supported in default-server: No
10934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010935 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10936
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010937on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010938 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10939 Currently, four modes are available:
10940 - fastinter: force fastinter
10941 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10942 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10943 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10944 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010946 Supported in default-server: Yes
10947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010948 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10949
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010950on-marked-down <action>
10951 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10952 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010953 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10954 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10955 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10956 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10957 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10958 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10959 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10960 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010961
10962 Actions are disabled by default
10963
10964 Supported in default-server: Yes
10965
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010966on-marked-up <action>
10967 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10968 Currently one action is available:
10969 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10970 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10971 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10972 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10973 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10974 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10975 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10976 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10977
10978 Actions are disabled by default
10979
10980 Supported in default-server: Yes
10981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010982port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010983 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10984 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10985 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10986 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10987 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10988 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010990 Supported in default-server: Yes
10991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010992redir <prefix>
10993 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10994 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10995 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10996 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10997 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10998 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10999 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11000 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011001 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011002 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11003 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11004 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11005 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11006 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11007
11008 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011010 Supported in default-server: No
11011
11012rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011013 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11014 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11015 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011017 Supported in default-server: Yes
11018
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011019resolve-prefer <family>
11020 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11021 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11022 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11023 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11024
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011025 Default value: ipv6
11026
11027 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011028
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011029 Example:
11030
11031 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011032
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011033resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11034 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11035 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
11036 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
11037 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11038 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11039 configured network, another address is selected.
11040
11041 Supported in default-server: Yes
11042
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011043 Example:
11044
11045 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011046
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011047resolvers <id>
11048 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11049 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011050 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11051 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11052 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11053 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011054
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011055 Supported in default-server: No
11056
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011057 Example:
11058
11059 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011060
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011061 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011062
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011063send-proxy
11064 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11065 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11066 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11067 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011068 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11069 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11070 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11071 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11072 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11073 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11074 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11075 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11076 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11077 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
11078 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
11079 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011080
11081 Supported in default-server: No
11082
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011083send-proxy-v2
11084 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11085 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11086 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11087 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11088 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
11089 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
11090 option of the "bind" keyword.
11091
11092 Supported in default-server: No
11093
11094send-proxy-v2-ssl
11095 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11096 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11097 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11098 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11099 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11100 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11101 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
11102 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11103
11104 Supported in default-server: No
11105
11106send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11107 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11108 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11109 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11110 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11111 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11112 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11113 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11114 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
11115 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11116
11117 Supported in default-server: No
11118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011119slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011120 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11121 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11122 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11123 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11124 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11125 parameters :
11126
11127 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11128 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11129
11130 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11131 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11132 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11133 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11134
11135 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11136 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11137 seen as failed.
11138
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011139 Supported in default-server: Yes
11140
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011141sni <expression>
11142 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11143 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11144 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11145 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11146 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11147
11148 Supported in default-server: no
11149
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011150source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011151source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011152source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011153 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11154 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11155 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11156 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11157
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011158 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11159 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11160 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11161 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11162 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11163 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11164 server.
11165
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011166 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11167 specifying the source address without port(s).
11168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011169 Supported in default-server: No
11170
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011171ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011172 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11173 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11174 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11175 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11176 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11177 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011178 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011179
11180 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011181
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011182tcp-ut <delay>
11183 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11184 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11185 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
11186 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
11187 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11188 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11189 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11190 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11191 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11192 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11193 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11194 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11195 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011197track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011198 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11199 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11200 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11201 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011202 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011204 Supported in default-server: No
11205
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011206verify [none|required]
11207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011208 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11209 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11210 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11211 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011212 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11213 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11214 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011215
11216 Supported in default-server: No
11217
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011218verifyhost <hostname>
11219 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11220 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11221 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11222 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11223 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11224 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
11225
11226 Supported in default-server: No
11227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011228weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011229 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11230 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11231 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011232 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11233 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11234 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11235 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11236 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11237 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011238
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011239 Supported in default-server: Yes
11240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011241
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200112425.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11243-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011244
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011245HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11246using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11247configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011248This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11249can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11250workload.
11251This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11252resolution at run time.
11253Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11254carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11255
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011256Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11257health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11258
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011259
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200112605.3.1. Global overview
11261----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011262
11263As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11264different steps of the process life:
11265
11266 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11267 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11268 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11269
11270 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11271 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11272 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11273
11274A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11275 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11276 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11277 resolution to know this new IP.
11278
11279A few things important to notice:
11280 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11281 first valid response.
11282
11283 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11284 servers return an error.
11285
11286
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200112875.3.2. The resolvers section
11288----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011289
11290This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11291HAProxy.
11292There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11293many name servers.
11294
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011295When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11296uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11297is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11298answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11299
11300When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11301used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11302
11303Two types of behavior can be applied:
11304 1. stop DNS resolution
11305 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11306 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11307 1. ANY query type
11308 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11309 server's parameter
11310 3. remaining family type
11311
11312HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11313 - invalid DNS response packet
11314 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11315 - NX domain
11316 - Query refused by server
11317 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11318
11319HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11320 - no Answer records in the response
11321 - DNS response truncated
11322 - Error in DNS response
11323 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11324 - name server timeout
11325
11326For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11327 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11328 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11329 applied;
11330 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11331 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11332 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11333 stops resolution.
11334
11335
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011336resolvers <resolvers id>
11337 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11338
11339A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11340
11341nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11342 DNS server description:
11343 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11344 <ip> : IP address of the server
11345 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11346
11347hold <status> <period>
11348 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11349 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011350 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11351 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011352 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11353 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11354 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11355
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011356 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011357
11358 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11359 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11360 the healch check.
11361
11362resolve_retries <nb>
11363 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11364 giving up.
11365 Default value: 3
11366
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011367 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11368 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11369 type.
11370
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011371timeout <event> <time>
11372 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11373 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11374 events available are:
11375 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11376 been received.
11377 Default value: 1s
11378 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11379 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11380
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011381 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011382
11383 resolvers mydns
11384 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11385 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11386 resolve_retries 3
11387 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011388 hold other 30s
11389 hold refused 30s
11390 hold nx 30s
11391 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011392 hold valid 10s
11393
11394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113956. HTTP header manipulation
11396---------------------------
11397
11398In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11399response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11400request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11401which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011402against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011403
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011404If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11405to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11406but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11407HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11408stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11409because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11410a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11411still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011413This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11414in section 4.2 :
11415
11416 - reqadd <string>
11417 - reqallow <search>
11418 - reqiallow <search>
11419 - reqdel <search>
11420 - reqidel <search>
11421 - reqdeny <search>
11422 - reqideny <search>
11423 - reqpass <search>
11424 - reqipass <search>
11425 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11426 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11427 - reqtarpit <search>
11428 - reqitarpit <search>
11429 - rspadd <string>
11430 - rspdel <search>
11431 - rspidel <search>
11432 - rspdeny <search>
11433 - rspideny <search>
11434 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11435 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11436
11437With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11438is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11439parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11440prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11441Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11442
11443 \t for a tab
11444 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11445 \n for a new line (LF)
11446 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11447 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11448 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11449 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11450 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11451
11452The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11453portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11454above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11455regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
114569 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11457is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11458
11459The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11460after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11461
11462Notes related to these keywords :
11463---------------------------------
11464 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11465 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11466 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11467
11468 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11469 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11470 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11471
11472 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11473 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11474 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11475 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11476 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11477
11478 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11479 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11480 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11481 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11482 useless headers before adding new ones.
11483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011484 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011485 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11486
11487 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11488 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11489 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11490
11491 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11492 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011493 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011494
11495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114967. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11497----------------------------------
11498
11499Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11500client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11501The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11502these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11503but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11504data called patterns.
11505
11506
115077.1. ACL basics
11508---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011509
11510The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11511content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11512from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11513simple :
11514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011515 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011516 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011517 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11518 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011520The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11521adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011522
11523In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011525 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011526
11527This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11528Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11529and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011530an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11531conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11532as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11533are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011534
11535ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11536'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11537which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11538
11539There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11540performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011542The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11543specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11544this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011545methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11546ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011547
11548Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11549 - boolean
11550 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11551 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11552 - string
11553 - data block
11554
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011555Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11556converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11557would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11558The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11559which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11560
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011561Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11562keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11563fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11564which are summarized in the table below :
11565
11566 +---------------------+-----------------+
11567 | Sample or converter | Default |
11568 | output type | matching method |
11569 +---------------------+-----------------+
11570 | boolean | bool |
11571 +---------------------+-----------------+
11572 | integer | int |
11573 +---------------------+-----------------+
11574 | ip | ip |
11575 +---------------------+-----------------+
11576 | string | str |
11577 +---------------------+-----------------+
11578 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11579 +---------------------+-----------------+
11580
11581Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11582matching method, see below.
11583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011584The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11585 - boolean
11586 - integer or integer range
11587 - IP address / network
11588 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11589 - regular expression
11590 - hex block
11591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011592The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11593
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011594 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11595 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011596 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011597 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011598 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011599 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011600 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011602The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11603read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11604if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11605lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11606will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11607beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11608a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11609lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11610exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11611
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011612The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11613parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11614ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11615a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11616check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11617
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011618The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11619socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11620file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011622Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11623loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11624
11625 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11626
11627In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11628the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11629case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11630as well.
11631
11632The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11633sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11634do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11635methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11636is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11637obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11638followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11639default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11640that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11641string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11642
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011643The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11644By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11645string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11646resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11647server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11648waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11649flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11650function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011652There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11653sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11654be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011655
11656 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11657 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011658 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11659 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11660 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11661 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011662
11663 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11664 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011665 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011666
11667 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011668 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011669
11670 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011671 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011672
11673 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11674 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11675
11676 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11677 binary or string samples.
11678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011679 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11680 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011682 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11683 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11684 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011686 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11687 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011689 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11690 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011692 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11693 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011695 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11696 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011697 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011699 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11700 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11701 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011702
11703For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11704request, it is possible to do :
11705
11706 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11707
11708In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11709buffer, one would use the following acl :
11710
11711 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11712
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011713On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11714possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11715
11716 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011718All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11719criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11720method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11721to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11722criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11723the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011725If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011726the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11727For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011729 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11730 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11731 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11732 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011733
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011734
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011735The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11736types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11737combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11738brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11739default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011741 +-------------------------------------------------+
11742 | Input sample type |
11743 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011744 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011745 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11746 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11747 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011748 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011749 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011750 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011751 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011752 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011753 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011754 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011755 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011756 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011757 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011758 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011759 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011760 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011761 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011762 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011763 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011764 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011765 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011766 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011767 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011768 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011769 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11770 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11771 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011772
11773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117747.1.1. Matching booleans
11775------------------------
11776
11777In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11778Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11779When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11780that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11781
11782Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11783return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11784"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11785
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117877.1.2. Matching integers
11788------------------------
11789
11790Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11791enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11792to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11793
11794Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11795matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11796lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011797
11798For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11799unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11800representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11801
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011802As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11803two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11804instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11805ranges and operators.
11806
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011807For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011808operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11809Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11810of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011811
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011812Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011813
11814 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11815 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11816 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11817 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11818 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11819
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011820For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011821
11822 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11823
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011824This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11825
11826 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11827
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118297.1.3. Matching strings
11830-----------------------
11831
11832String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11833different forms :
11834
11835 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11836 patterns ;
11837
11838 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11839 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11840
11841 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11842 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11843
11844 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11845 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11846
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011847 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011848 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11849 matches.
11850
11851 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11852 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11853 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011854
11855String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11856exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11857characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11858string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11859to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011860before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011861
11862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118637.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11864---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011865
11866Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11867they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11868possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11869passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11870the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011871the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11872match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011873
11874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11876-------------------------------------
11877
11878It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11879not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11880a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11881to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11882digits may be used upper or lower case.
11883
11884Example :
11885 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11886 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11887
11888
118897.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11890---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011891
11892IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11893netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11894within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011895host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011896difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11897at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11898does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11899parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011900
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011901The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11902abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11903
11904 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11905 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11906 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11907 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11908 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11909 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11910 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11911 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11912
11913Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11914192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11915
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011916IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11917Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11918trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11919IPv6 patterns.
11920
11921HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11922following situations :
11923 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11924 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11925 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11926 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11927 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11928 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11929 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11930 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11931 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11932 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011934
119357.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11936----------------------------------
11937
11938Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11939combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11940
11941 - AND (implicit)
11942 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11943 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011945A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011947 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011949Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11950indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011952For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11953"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11954requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11955is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11956
11957 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11958 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11959 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11960 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11961
11962To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11963and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11964
11965 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11966 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11967 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11968 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11969
11970 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11971 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11972 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11973 use_backend www if host_www
11974
11975It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11976expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11977be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11978the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11979
11980 The following rule :
11981
11982 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11983 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11984
11985 Can also be written that way :
11986
11987 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11988
11989It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11990to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11991simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11992sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11993good use is the following :
11994
11995 With named ACLs :
11996
11997 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11998 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11999 monitor fail if site_dead
12000
12001 With anonymous ACLs :
12002
12003 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12004
12005See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
12006
12007
120087.3. Fetching samples
12009---------------------
12010
12011Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12012against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12013sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12014ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12015of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12016available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12017
12018This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12019Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12020compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12021deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12022
12023The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12024matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12025method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12026indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12027
12028As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12029when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12030mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12031the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12032ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12033
12034Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12035multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12036when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12037incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12038are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12039is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12040all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12041
12042Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12043 - name
12044 - name(arg1)
12045 - name(arg1,arg2)
12046
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012047
120487.3.1. Converters
12049-----------------
12050
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012051Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12052of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12053is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12054was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12055has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12056unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12057
12058These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12059sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12060the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12061support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012062
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012063A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12064support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12065supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12066(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12067bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012069The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012070
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012071add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012072 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012073 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012074 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12075 scopes allowed are:
12076 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12077 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12078 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12079 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12080 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012081 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012082
12083and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012084 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012085 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012086 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12087 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12088 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12089 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12090 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12091 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12092 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012093 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012094
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012095base64
12096 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12097 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12098 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12099
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012100bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012101 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012102 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12103 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12104 presence of a flag).
12105
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012106bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12107 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12108 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
12109 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
12110
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012111cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012112 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12113 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012114
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012115crc32([<avalanche>])
12116 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12117 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12118 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12119 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12120 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12121 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12122 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12123 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12124 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12125 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12126 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12127
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012128da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012129 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12130 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12131 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12132 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012133 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012134 configuration language.
12135
12136 Example:
12137 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012138 bind *:8881
12139 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012140 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012141
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012142debug
12143 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12144 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12145 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12146
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012147div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012148 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12149 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012150 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012151 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12152 scope. The scopes allowed are:
12153 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12154 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12155 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12156 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12157 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012158 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012159
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012160djb2([<avalanche>])
12161 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12162 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12163 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12164 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12165 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12166 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12167 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012168 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12169 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012170
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012171even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012172 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012173 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12174
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012175field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12176 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12177 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12178 list of chars.
12179
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012180hex
12181 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12182 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12183 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12184 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012185
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012186http_date([<offset>])
12187 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12188 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12189 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12190 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12191 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12192 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012193
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012194in_table(<table>)
12195 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12196 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12197 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12198 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12199 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12200
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012201ipmask(<mask>)
12202 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12203 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12204 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12205 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12206
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012207json([<input-code>])
12208 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12209 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012210 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012211 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12212 of errors:
12213 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12214 bytes, ...)
12215 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12216 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12217
12218 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12219 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12220 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12221 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12222 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12223 are :
12224 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12225 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12226 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12227 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12228 error ;
12229 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12230 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12231
12232 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12233 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12234
12235 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012236 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012237 capture request header user-agent len 150
12238 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012239
12240 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12241 GET / HTTP/1.0
12242 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12243
12244 Output log:
12245 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12246
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012247language(<value>[,<default>])
12248 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12249 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12250 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12251 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12252 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12253 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12254 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12255 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12256 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12257 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12258 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12259 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012260
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012261 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012262
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012263 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12264 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012265
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012266 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12267 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12268 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12269 use_backend spanish if es
12270 use_backend french if fr
12271 use_backend english if en
12272 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012273
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012274lower
12275 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12276 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12277 type. The result is of type string.
12278
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012279ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12280 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12281 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12282 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12283 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12284 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12285 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12286
12287 Example :
12288
12289 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12290 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12291 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12292
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012293map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12294map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12295map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12296 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12297 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12298 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12299 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12300 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12301 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12302 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12303 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012304
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012305 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12306 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12307 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012308
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012309 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
12310 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012311
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012312 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12313 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12314 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12315 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012316 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12317 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012318 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12319 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12320 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12321 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12322 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12323 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12324 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12325 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012326 | | map_reg | |
12327 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12328 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012329 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12330 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12331 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12332 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12333 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012334
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012335 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12336 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12337 the corresponding match text.
12338
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012339 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12340 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12341 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12342 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12343 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012344
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012345 Example :
12346
12347 # this is a comment and is ignored
12348 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12349 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12350 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12351 | | | `---------- value
12352 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12353 | `---------------------------- key
12354 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12355
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012356mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012357 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12358 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012359 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012360 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12361 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12362 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12363 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12364 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12365 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012366 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012367
12368mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012369 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012370 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12371 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012372 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012373 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12374 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12375 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12376 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12377 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12378 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012379 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012380
12381neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012382 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12383 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12384 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12385 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012386
12387not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012388 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012389 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12390 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12391 absence of a flag).
12392
12393odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012394 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012395 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12396
12397or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012398 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012399 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012400 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12401 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12402 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12403 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12404 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12405 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12406 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012407 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012408
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012409regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012410 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12411 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12412 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12413 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12414 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12415 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12416 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12417 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12418 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12419 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012420 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12421 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12422 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12423 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012424
12425 Example :
12426
12427 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12428 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12429 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12430 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12431
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012432capture-req(<id>)
12433 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12434 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12435
12436 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012437 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12438 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012439
12440capture-res(<id>)
12441 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12442 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12443
12444 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012445 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12446 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012447
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012448sdbm([<avalanche>])
12449 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12450 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12451 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12452 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12453 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12454 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12455 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012456 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12457 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012458
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012459set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012460 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12461 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12462 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12463 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12464 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012465 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012466 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12467 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012468 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12469 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12470
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012471sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012472 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12473 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012474 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012475 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12476 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12477 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12478 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012479 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012480 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12481 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012482 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12483 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012484
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012485table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12486 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12487 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12488 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12489 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12490 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12491 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12492
12493
12494table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12495 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12496 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12497 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12498 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12499 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12500 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12501
12502table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12503 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12504 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12505 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12506 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12507 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12508
12509table_conn_cur(<table>)
12510 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12511 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12512 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12513 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12514 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12515
12516table_conn_rate(<table>)
12517 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12518 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12519 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12520 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12521 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12522
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012523table_gpt0(<table>)
12524 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12525 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12526 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12527 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12528 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12529
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012530table_gpc0(<table>)
12531 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12532 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12533 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12534 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12535 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12536
12537table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12538 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12539 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12540 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12541 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12542 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12543 sample fetch keyword.
12544
12545table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12546 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12547 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12548 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12549 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12550 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12551
12552table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12553 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12554 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12555 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12556 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12557 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12558 keyword.
12559
12560table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12561 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12562 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12563 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12564 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12565 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12566
12567table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12568 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12569 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12570 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12571 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12572 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12573 keyword.
12574
12575table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12576 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12577 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12578 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12579 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12580 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12581 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12582 keyword.
12583
12584table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12585 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12586 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12587 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12588 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12589 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12590 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12591 keyword.
12592
12593table_server_id(<table>)
12594 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12595 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12596 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12597 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12598 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12599 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12600
12601table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12602 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12603 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12604 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12605 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12606 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12607 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12608 keyword.
12609
12610table_sess_rate(<table>)
12611 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12612 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12613 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12614 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12615 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12616 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12617 keyword.
12618
12619table_trackers(<table>)
12620 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12621 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12622 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12623 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12624 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12625 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12626 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12627 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12628 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12629 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12630
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012631upper
12632 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12633 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12634 type. The result is of type string.
12635
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012636url_dec
12637 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12638 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12639
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012640utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12641 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12642 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12643 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12644 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12645 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12646 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12647
12648 Example :
12649
12650 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12651 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12652 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12653
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012654word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12655 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12656 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12657
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012658wt6([<avalanche>])
12659 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12660 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12661 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12662 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12663 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12664 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12665 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012666 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12667 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012668
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012669xor(<value>)
12670 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012671 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012672 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012673 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12674 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12675 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012676 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012677 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12678 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012679 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12680 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012681
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012682
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200126837.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012684--------------------------------------------
12685
12686A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12687not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12688"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12689The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12690
12691always_false : boolean
12692 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12693 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12694
12695always_true : boolean
12696 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12697 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12698
12699avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012700 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012701 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12702 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12703 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12704 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12705 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12706 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12707 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12708 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12709 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12710 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12711 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12712 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12713 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012715be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012716 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12717 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12718 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12719 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12720 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012722be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12723 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12724 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12725 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12726 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12727 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12728 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012729
12730 Example :
12731 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12732 backend dynamic
12733 mode http
12734 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12735 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012736
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012737bin(<hexa>) : bin
12738 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12739 of the string.
12740
12741bool(<bool>) : bool
12742 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12743 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012745connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12746 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012747 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012748 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12749 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012750
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012751 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012752 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012753 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12754
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012755 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12756 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012757
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012758 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012759 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012760 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012761 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12762 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012763 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012764 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012765
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012766 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12767 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012768 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012769 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012770
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012771date([<offset>]) : integer
12772 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12773 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12774 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12775 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012776 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12777
12778 Example :
12779
12780 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12781 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012782
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012783env(<name>) : string
12784 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12785 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12786 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12787 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12788 certain way.
12789
12790 Examples :
12791 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12792 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12793
12794 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12795 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012797fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12798 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012799 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12800 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012801 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12802 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12803 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12804 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12805 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012806
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020012807fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12808 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
12809 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
12810 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
12811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012812fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12813 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12814 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12815 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12816 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12817 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12818 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12819 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12820 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012821
12822 Example :
12823 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12824 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12825 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12826 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12827 frontend mail
12828 bind :25
12829 mode tcp
12830 maxconn 100
12831 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12832 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12833 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12834 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012835
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012836int(<integer>) : signed integer
12837 Returns a signed integer.
12838
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012839ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12840 Returns an ipv4.
12841
12842ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12843 Returns an ipv6.
12844
12845meth(<method>) : method
12846 Returns a method.
12847
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012848nbproc : integer
12849 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12850 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12851 and debugging purposes.
12852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012853nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12854 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12855 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12856 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012857 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12858 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12859 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012860
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012861proc : integer
12862 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12863 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12864 debugging purposes.
12865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012866queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012867 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12868 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12869 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012870 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12871 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12872 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12873 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12874 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12875
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012876rand([<range>]) : integer
12877 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12878 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12879 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12880 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12881 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012883srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12884 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12885 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12886 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12887 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12888 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12889 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12890 methods.
12891
12892srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12893 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12894 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12895 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12896 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12897 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12898 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12899 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12900
12901srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12902 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12903 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012904 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012905 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12906 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12907 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12908 overloading servers).
12909
12910 Example :
12911 # Redirect to a separate back
12912 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12913 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12914 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12915
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012916stopping : boolean
12917 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12918 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12919 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12920
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012921str(<string>) : string
12922 Returns a string.
12923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012924table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12925 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12926 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12927
12928table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12929 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12930 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12931 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12932
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012933var(<var-name>) : undefined
12934 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012935 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12936 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12937 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12938 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012939 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012940 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12941 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012942 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12943 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12944
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129457.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012946----------------------------------
12947
12948The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12949closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12950methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12951sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12952TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012953the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12954counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12955"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012956argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12957the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12958this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012959
12960be_id : integer
12961 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12962 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12963
12964dst : ip
12965 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12966 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12967 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12968 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12969 RFC 4291.
12970
12971dst_conn : integer
12972 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12973 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12974 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12975 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12976 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12977 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12978 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12979 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012980
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020012981dst_is_local : boolean
12982 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
12983 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
12984 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
12985 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
12986 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
12987 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
12988 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
12989 it only once per connection.
12990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012991dst_port : integer
12992 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12993 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12994 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12995 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12996 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12997 an HTTP header.
12998
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020012999fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13000 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13001 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13002 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13003 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13004 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13005 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13006
13007fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13008 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13009 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13010 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13011 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13012 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13013 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13014
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013015fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13016 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13017 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13018 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13019 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13020
13021fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13022 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13023 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13024 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13025 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13026
13027fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13028 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13029 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13030 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13031 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13032
13033fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13034 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13035 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13036 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13037 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13038
13039fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13040 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13041 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13042 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13043 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13044
13045fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13046 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13047 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13048 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13049 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013051fe_id : integer
13052 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
13053 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
13054 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13055
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013056sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013057sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13058sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13059sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013060 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13061 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13062 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13063
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013064sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013065sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13066sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13067sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013068 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13069 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13070 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13071
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013072sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013073sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13074sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13075sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013076 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13077 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013078 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13079 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13080 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013081
13082 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13083 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013084 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13085 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13086 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013087 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13088 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13089
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013090sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013091sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13092sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13093sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013094 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13095 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13096
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013097sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013098sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13099sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13100sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013101 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13102 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13103 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13104
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013105sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013106sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13107sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13108sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013109 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13110 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13111 See also src_conn_rate.
13112
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013113sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013114sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13115sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13116sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013117 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013118 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013119
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013120sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13121sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13122sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13123sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13124 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13125 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13126
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013127sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013128sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13129sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13130sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013131 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13132 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13133 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013134 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13135 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13136 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013137
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013138sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013139sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13140sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13141sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013142 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13143 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13144 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13145
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013146sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013147sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13148sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13149sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013150 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13151 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13152 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13153 src_http_err_rate.
13154
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013155sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013156sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13157sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13158sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013159 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13160 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13161 src_http_req_cnt.
13162
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013163sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013164sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13165sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13166sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013167 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13168 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13169 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13170 src_http_req_rate.
13171
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013172sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013173sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13174sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13175sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013176 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013177 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13178 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13179 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13180 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013181
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013182 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13183 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013184 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13185
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013186sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013187sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13188sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13189sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013190 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13191 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13192 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013193
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013194sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013195sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13196sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13197sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013198 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13199 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13200 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013201
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013202sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013203sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13204sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13205sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013206 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13207 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13208 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13209 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013210 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013211 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13212
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013213sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013214sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13215sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13216sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013217 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13218 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13219 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13220 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13221 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013222 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013223
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013224sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013225sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13226sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13227sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013228 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13229 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13230 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13231
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013232sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013233sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13234sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13235sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013236 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13237 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013238 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013239 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13240 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013241 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13242 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13243 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013245so_id : integer
13246 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13247 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13248 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013250src : ip
13251 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13252 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13253 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13254 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013255 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13256 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13257 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13258 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013259
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013260 Example:
13261 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13262 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013264src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13265 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13266 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13267 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013268 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013270src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13271 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13272 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013273 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013274 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013276src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13277 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13278 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13279 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13280 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13281 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13282 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013283
13284 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13285 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13286 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13287 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013288 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013289 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13290 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013292src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013293 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013294 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013295 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013296 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013298src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013299 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013300 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13301 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013302 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13305 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13306 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13307 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013308 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013310src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013311 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013312 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013313 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013314 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013315
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013316src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13317 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13318 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13319 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13320 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013322src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013323 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013324 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013325 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13326 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013327 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13328 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13329 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013331src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13332 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13333 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013334 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013335 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013336 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013338src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13339 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13340 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13341 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13342 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013343 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013345src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13346 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13347 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13348 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013349 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013351src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13352 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13353 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13354 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013355 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013356 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013358src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13359 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13360 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13361 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013362 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013363 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13364 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013365
13366 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013367 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013368 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013369
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013370src_is_local : boolean
13371 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13372 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13373 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13374 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13375 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13376 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13377 once per connection.
13378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013379src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013380 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13381 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13382 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13383 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13384 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013386src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013387 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13388 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13389 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13390 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13391 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013393src_port : integer
13394 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13395 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13396 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13397 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013399src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13400 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013401 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13402 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13403 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013404 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013406src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13407 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13408 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13409 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13410 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013411 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013413src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13414 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13415 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13416 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13417 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13418 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13419 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13420 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13421 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013422
13423 Example :
13424 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13425 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13426 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13427 listen ssh
13428 bind :22
13429 mode tcp
13430 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013431 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013432 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013433 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013435srv_id : integer
13436 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13437 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13438 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013439
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200134407.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013441----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013443The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13444closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13445when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13446usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013447future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013448
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013449ssl_bc : boolean
13450 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13451 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13452 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13453
13454ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13455 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13456 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13457
13458ssl_bc_cipher : string
13459 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13460 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13461
13462ssl_bc_protocol : string
13463 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13464 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13465
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013466ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013467 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013468 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13469 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013470
13471ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13472 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13473 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13474 if session was reused or not.
13475
13476ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13477 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13478 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013480ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13481 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13482 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13483 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13484 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13485 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013487ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13488 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13489 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13490 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13491 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013492
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013493ssl_c_der : binary
13494 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13495 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13496 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013498ssl_c_err : integer
13499 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13500 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13501 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13502 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13503 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013505ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13506 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13507 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13508 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13509 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13510 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13511 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13512 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13513 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013515ssl_c_key_alg : string
13516 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13517 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13518 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013520ssl_c_notafter : string
13521 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13522 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13523 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013525ssl_c_notbefore : string
13526 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13527 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13528 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013530ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13531 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13532 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13533 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13534 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13535 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13536 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13537 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13538 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013540ssl_c_serial : binary
13541 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13542 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13543 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013545ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13546 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13547 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13548 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013549 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13550 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13551
13552 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013554ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13555 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13556 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13557 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013559ssl_c_used : boolean
13560 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13561 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013563ssl_c_verify : integer
13564 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13565 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13566 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13567 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013569ssl_c_version : integer
13570 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13571 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013572
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013573ssl_f_der : binary
13574 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13575 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13576 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013578ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13579 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13580 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13581 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13582 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013583 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013584 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13585 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13586 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013588ssl_f_key_alg : string
13589 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13590 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13591 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013593ssl_f_notafter : string
13594 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13595 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13596 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013598ssl_f_notbefore : string
13599 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13600 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13601 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013603ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13604 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13605 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13606 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13607 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13608 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13609 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13610 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13611 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013613ssl_f_serial : binary
13614 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13615 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13616 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013617
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013618ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13619 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13620 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13621 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013623ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13624 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13625 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13626 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013628ssl_f_version : integer
13629 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13630 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13631
13632ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013633 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13634 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13635 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013637 Example :
13638 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13639 listen http-https
13640 bind :80
13641 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13642 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13643
13644ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13645 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13646 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13647
13648ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013649 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013650 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13651 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13652 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13653 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13654 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13655 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13656 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13657 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013659ssl_fc_cipher : string
13660 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13661 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013663ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013664 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13665 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013666 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13667 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13668 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13669 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013671ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13672 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013673 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13674 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13675 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13676 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013677
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013678ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013679 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13680 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013682ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013683 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013684 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13685 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13686 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13687 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13688 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13689 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13690 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013692ssl_fc_protocol : string
13693 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13694 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013695
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013696ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013697 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013698 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13699 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013701ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13702 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13703 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13704 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13705 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013707ssl_fc_sni : string
13708 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13709 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13710 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13711 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13712 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13713
13714 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13715 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13716 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013717 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13718 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013720 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013721 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13722 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013724ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13725 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13726 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013727
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013728
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200137297.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013730------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013732Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13733sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13734only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13735For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13736be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13737can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13738sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13739for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13740content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013742payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13743 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13744 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13745 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013747payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13748 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13749 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13750 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013752req.len : integer
13753req_len : integer (deprecated)
13754 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13755 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13756 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13757 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13758 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13759 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13760 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13761 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013763req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13764 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013765 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13766 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13767 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13768 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013770 ACL alternatives :
13771 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013773req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13774 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13775 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13776 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13777 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013779 ACL alternatives :
13780 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013782 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013784req.proto_http : boolean
13785req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13786 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13787 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13788 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13789 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13790 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13791 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13792 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013794 Example:
13795 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13796 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13797 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013798 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013800req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13801rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13802 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13803 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13804 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13805 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13806 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13807 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13808 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013810 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13811 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13812 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13813 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13814 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13815 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013817 ACL derivatives :
13818 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013820 Example :
13821 listen tse-farm
13822 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13823 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13824 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13825 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13826 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13827 persist rdp-cookie
13828 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13829 # This is only useful makes sense if
13830 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13831 stick-table type string size 204800
13832 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13833 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13834 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013836 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13837 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013839req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13840rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13841 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13842 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13843 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13844 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013846 ACL derivatives :
13847 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013848
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013849req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13850 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13851 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013852 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13853 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13854 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13855 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13856 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013858req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13859req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13860 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13861 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13862 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13863 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13864 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13865 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13866 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013868req.ssl_sni : string
13869req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13870 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13871 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13872 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13873 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13874 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13875 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13876 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13877 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13878 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13879 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13880 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13881 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013883 ACL derivatives :
13884 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013886 Examples :
13887 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13888 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13889 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13890 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13891 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013892
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013893req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13894 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13895 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13896 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13897 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13898 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13899 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13900 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13901 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13902 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013904req.ssl_ver : integer
13905req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13906 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13907 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13908 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13909 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13910 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13911 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13912 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13913 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13914 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013916 ACL derivatives :
13917 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013918
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013919res.len : integer
13920 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13921 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13922 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13923 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13924 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13925 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13926 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13927 content inspection.
13928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013929res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13930 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013931 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13932 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13933 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13934 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013936res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13937 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13938 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13939 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13940 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013942 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013943
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013944res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13945rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13946 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13947 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13948 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13949 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13950 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13951 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13952 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954wait_end : boolean
13955 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13956 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13957 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13958 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13959 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13960 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13961 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13962 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013964 Examples :
13965 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13966 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13967 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013969 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13970 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13971 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13972 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13973 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13974 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13975 tcp-request content reject
13976
13977
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139787.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013979--------------------------------------
13980
13981It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13982This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13983data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13984its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13985HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13986content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13987to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13988more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13989response are indexed.
13990
13991base : string
13992 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13993 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13994 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13995 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13996 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13997 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13998 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13999 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14000
14001 ACL derivatives :
14002 base : exact string match
14003 base_beg : prefix match
14004 base_dir : subdir match
14005 base_dom : domain match
14006 base_end : suffix match
14007 base_len : length match
14008 base_reg : regex match
14009 base_sub : substring match
14010
14011base32 : integer
14012 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14013 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14014 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014015 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14016 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14017 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018
14019base32+src : binary
14020 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14021 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14022 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14023 per-URL counters.
14024
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014025capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14026 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14027 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14028 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14029
14030capture.req.method : string
14031 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14032 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14033 because it's allocated.
14034
14035capture.req.uri : string
14036 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14037 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14038 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14039 allocated.
14040
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014041capture.req.ver : string
14042 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14043 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14044 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14045
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014046capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14047 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14048 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14049 The first entry is an index of 0.
14050 See also: "capture response header"
14051
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014052capture.res.ver : string
14053 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14054 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14055 persistent flag.
14056
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014057req.body : binary
14058 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14059 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14060 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14061 the first chunk is analyzed.
14062
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014063req.body_param([<name>) : string
14064 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14065 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14066 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14067 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14068 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14069 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14070 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14071 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14072 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14073 given.
14074
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014075req.body_len : integer
14076 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14077 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14078 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14079 "option http-buffer-request".
14080
14081req.body_size : integer
14082 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14083 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14084 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14085 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14086 "option http-buffer-request".
14087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014088req.cook([<name>]) : string
14089cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14090 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14091 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14092 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14093 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14094 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14095 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14096 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14097 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14098
14099 ACL derivatives :
14100 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14101 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14102 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14103 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14104 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14105 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14106 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14107 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014109req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14110cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14111 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14112 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014114req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14115cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14116 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14117 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14118 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14119 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014121cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14122 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14123 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14124 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14125 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014126 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014127 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14128 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14129 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14130 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014132hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14133 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14134 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14135 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14136 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014137 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014139req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14140 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14141 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14142 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14143 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14144 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14145 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14146 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14147 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014149req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14150 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14151 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14152 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14153 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014155req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14156 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14157 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14158 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14159 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14160 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14161 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14162 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14163 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14164 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14165 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14166 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014168 ACL derivatives :
14169 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14170 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14171 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14172 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14173 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14174 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14175 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14176 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14177
14178req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14179hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14180 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14181 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14182 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14183 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14184 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14185 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14186 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14187 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14188 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14189
14190req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14191hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14192 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14193 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14194 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14195 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14196 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14197 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14198 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14199 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14200
14201req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14202hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14203 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14204 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14205 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14206 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14207 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14208 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14209 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14210
14211http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14212 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14213 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14214 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14215 basic auth is supported.
14216
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014217http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14218 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14219 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14220 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14221 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014222 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14223 basic auth is supported.
14224
14225 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014226 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14227 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14228 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14229 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014230
14231http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014232 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14233 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014234 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14235 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014237method : integer + string
14238 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14239 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14240 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14241 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14242 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14243 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14244 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014246 ACL derivatives :
14247 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014249 Example :
14250 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14251 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14252 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254path : string
14255 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14256 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14257 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14258 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14259 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14260 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14261 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014263 ACL derivatives :
14264 path : exact string match
14265 path_beg : prefix match
14266 path_dir : subdir match
14267 path_dom : domain match
14268 path_end : suffix match
14269 path_len : length match
14270 path_reg : regex match
14271 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014272
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014273query : string
14274 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14275 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14276 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14277 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
14278 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
14279 which stops before the question mark.
14280
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014281req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14282 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14283 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14284 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14285 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287req.ver : string
14288req_ver : string (deprecated)
14289 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14290 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14291 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014293 ACL derivatives :
14294 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014296res.comp : boolean
14297 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14298 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14299 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014301res.comp_algo : string
14302 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14303 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14304 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014306res.cook([<name>]) : string
14307scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14308 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14309 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14310 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014312 ACL derivatives :
14313 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014315res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14316scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14317 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14318 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14319 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014321res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14322scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14323 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14324 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14325 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014327res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14328 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14329 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14330 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14331 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14332 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14333 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14334 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14335 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14336 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14339 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14340 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14341 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14342 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14343 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014345res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14346shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14347 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14348 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14349 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14350 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14351 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14352 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14353 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14354 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014356 ACL derivatives :
14357 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14358 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14359 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14360 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14361 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14362 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14363 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14364 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14365
14366res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14367shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14368 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14369 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14370 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14371 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14372 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014374res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14375shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14376 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14377 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14378 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14379 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14380 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14381 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014382
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014383res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14384 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14385 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14386 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14387 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014389res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14390shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14391 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14392 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14393 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14394 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14395 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14396 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398res.ver : string
14399resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14400 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14401 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014403 ACL derivatives :
14404 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014406set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14407 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14408 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014409 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014410 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014412 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14413 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014415status : integer
14416 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14417 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14418 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014419
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014420unique-id : string
14421 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14422 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14423 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14424 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14425 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14426 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428url : string
14429 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14430 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14431 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14432 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14433 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14434 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14435 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014437 ACL derivatives :
14438 url : exact string match
14439 url_beg : prefix match
14440 url_dir : subdir match
14441 url_dom : domain match
14442 url_end : suffix match
14443 url_len : length match
14444 url_reg : regex match
14445 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014447url_ip : ip
14448 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14449 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14450 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14451 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14452 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14453 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14454 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014456url_port : integer
14457 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14458 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14459 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14460 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014461
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014462urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14463url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014464 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14465 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014466 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14467 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14468 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14469 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14471 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014472 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14473 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014475 ACL derivatives :
14476 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14477 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14478 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14479 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14480 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14481 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14482 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14483 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014484
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014486 Example :
14487 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14488 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14489 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14490 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014491
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014492urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014493 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14494 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14495 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014496
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014497url32 : integer
14498 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14499 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14500 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14501 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14502 is an unsigned integer.
14503
14504url32+src : binary
14505 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14506 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14507 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14508
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145107.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014511---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014513Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14514every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014515order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014517ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14518---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014519FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014520HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014521HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14522HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014523HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14524HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14525HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14526HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14527LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014528METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014529METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014530METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14531METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14532METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14533METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014534METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014535METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014536RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014537REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014538TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014539WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14540---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014541
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014542
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145438. Logging
14544----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014545
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014546One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14547provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14548very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14549provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14550state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014551to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014552headers.
14553
14554In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14555about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14556send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14557
14558 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14559 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14560 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14561 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14562 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014563 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14564 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014565
14566The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14567allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14568as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14569while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14570real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14571delay.
14572
14573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145748.1. Log levels
14575---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014576
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014577TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014578source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014579HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14580in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14581track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14582syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14583about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014584
14585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145868.2. Log formats
14587----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014588
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014589HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014590and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14591slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14592options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014593
14594 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14595 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14596 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14597 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14598 extents.
14599
14600 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14601 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14602 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14603 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14604 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14605
14606 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14607 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14608 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14609 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14610 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14611
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014612 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14613 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14614 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14615 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14616
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014617 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14618
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014619Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14620specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14621field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14622servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14623always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14624identifier.
14625
14626Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14627 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14628 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14629 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14630 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14631
14632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146338.2.1. Default log format
14634-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014635
14636This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14637as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14638format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14639
14640 Example :
14641 listen www
14642 mode http
14643 log global
14644 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14645
14646 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14647 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14648 (www/HTTP)
14649
14650 Field Format Extract from the example above
14651 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14652 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14653 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14654 4 'to' to
14655 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14656 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14657
14658Detailed fields description :
14659 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14660 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14661 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14662 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14663 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14664 and processed the connection.
14665 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14666
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014667In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14668"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14669connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14670
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014671It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14672will eventually disappear.
14673
14674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146758.2.2. TCP log format
14676---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014677
14678The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14679is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14680information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14681counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14682emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14683environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14684the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14685sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014686specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14687not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14688fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14689marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014690
14691 Example :
14692 frontend fnt
14693 mode tcp
14694 option tcplog
14695 log global
14696 default_backend bck
14697
14698 backend bck
14699 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14700
14701 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14702 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14703 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14704
14705 Field Format Extract from the example above
14706 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14707 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14708 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14709 4 frontend_name fnt
14710 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14711 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14712 7 bytes_read* 212
14713 8 termination_state --
14714 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14715 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14716
14717Detailed fields description :
14718 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014719 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14720 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14721 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014722 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14723 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14724 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014725
14726 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014727 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14728 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14729 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014730
14731 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14732 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14733 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14734 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14735
14736 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14737 and processed the connection.
14738
14739 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14740 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14741 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14742 applications.
14743
14744 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14745 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14746 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14747 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14748 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14749
14750 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14751 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14752 See "Timers" below for more details.
14753
14754 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14755 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14756 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14757 "Timers" below for more details.
14758
14759 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014760 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014761 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14762 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14763 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14764 details.
14765
14766 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14767 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14768 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14769 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14770 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14771
14772 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14773 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14774 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14775 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14776 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14777 for more details.
14778
14779 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014780 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014781 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14782 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14783 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014784 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014785
14786 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14787 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14788 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14789 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14790 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14791 caused by a denial of service attack.
14792
14793 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14794 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14795 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14796 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14797 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14798 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14799 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14800 denial of service attack.
14801
14802 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14803 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14804 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14805 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14806 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14807 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14808 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14809 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14810 be processed than on other servers.
14811
14812 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14813 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14814 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14815 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14816 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14817 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14818 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14819 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14820 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14821 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14822 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14823 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14824 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14825
14826 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14827 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14828 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14829 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14830 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14831 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14832 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14833 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14834
14835 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14836 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14837 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14838 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14839 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14840 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14841 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14842 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14843 occurs.
14844
14845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148468.2.3. HTTP log format
14847----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014848
14849The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14850is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14851the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14852are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14853emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14854generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14855"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14856which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014857frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14858is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014859
14860Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14861slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14862with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14863
14864 Example :
14865 frontend http-in
14866 mode http
14867 option httplog
14868 log global
14869 default_backend bck
14870
14871 backend static
14872 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14873
14874 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14875 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14876 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014877 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014878
14879 Field Format Extract from the example above
14880 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14881 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014882 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014883 4 frontend_name http-in
14884 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014885 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014886 7 status_code 200
14887 8 bytes_read* 2750
14888 9 captured_request_cookie -
14889 10 captured_response_cookie -
14890 11 termination_state ----
14891 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14892 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14893 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14894 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14895 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014896
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014897Detailed fields description :
14898 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014899 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14900 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14901 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014902 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14903 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14904 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014905
14906 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014907 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14908 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14909 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014910
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014911 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
14912 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014913
14914 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14915 and processed the connection.
14916
14917 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14918 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14919 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14920
14921 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14922 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14923 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14924 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14925 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14926 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14927
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014928 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
14929 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
14930 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
14931 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
14932 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
14933 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
14934 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014935
14936 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14937 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14938 See "Timers" below for more details.
14939
14940 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14941 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14942 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14943 below for more details.
14944
14945 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14946 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14947 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14948 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14949 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14950 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14951 for more details.
14952
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014953 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
14954 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
14955 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
14956 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
14957 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
14958 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
14959 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
14960 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014961
14962 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14963 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14964 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14965
14966 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14967 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14968 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14969 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14970 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14971 overflowing.
14972
14973 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14974 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14975 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14976 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14977 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14978 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14979 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14980 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14981
14982 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14983 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14984 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14985 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14986 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14987 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14988 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14989 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14990
14991 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14992 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14993 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14994 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14995 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14996 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14997 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14998
14999 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015000 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015001 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15002 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15003 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015004 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015005 system.
15006
15007 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15008 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15009 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15010 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15011 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15012 caused by a denial of service attack.
15013
15014 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15015 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15016 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15017 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15018 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15019 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15020 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15021 denial of service attack.
15022
15023 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15024 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15025 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15026 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15027 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15028 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15029 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15030 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15031 processed than on other servers.
15032
15033 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15034 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15035 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15036 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15037 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15038 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15039 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15040 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15041 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15042 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15043 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15044 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15045 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15046
15047 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15048 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15049 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15050 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15051 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15052 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15053 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15054 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15055
15056 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15057 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15058 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15059 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15060 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15061 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15062 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15063 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15064 occurs.
15065
15066 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15067 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15068 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15069 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15070 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15071 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15072 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15073 cookies" below for more details.
15074
15075 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15076 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15077 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15078 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15079 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15080 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15081 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15082 and cookies" below for more details.
15083
15084 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15085 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15086 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15087 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15088 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15089 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15090 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15091 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15092
15093
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200150948.2.4. Custom log format
15095------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015096
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015097The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015098mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015099
15100HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15101Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15102separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15103prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15104
15105Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15106variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015107("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015108
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015109If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015110as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015111less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15112the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15113
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015114Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015115In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015116in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015117
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015118Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15119'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15120https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15121such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15122
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015123Flags are :
15124 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015125 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015126 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15127 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015128
15129 Example:
15130
15131 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15132 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15133
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015134 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15135
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015136At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15137
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015138 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15139 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015140
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015141the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015142
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015143 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15144 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15145 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015146
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015147and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15148
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015149 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15150 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015151
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015152Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15153
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015154 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015155 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015156 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15157 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15158 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015159 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15160 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15161 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015162 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015163 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15164 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015165 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015166 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15167 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015168 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015169 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015170 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015171 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015172 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015173 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015174 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015175 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15176 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15177 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15178 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15179 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015180 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015181 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15182 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015183 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015184 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15185 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015186 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15187 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15188 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015189 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015190 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15191 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015192 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015193 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15194 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15195 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015196 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015197 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015198 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15199 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15200 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15201 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015202 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015203 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015204 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015205 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015206 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015207 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015208 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15209 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15210 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015211 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015212 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15213 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015214 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015215 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15216 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15217 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015218 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015219 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015220 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015221
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015222 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015223
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015224
152258.2.5. Error log format
15226-----------------------
15227
15228When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15229protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15230By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15231"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15232will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15233logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15234
15235The format looks like this :
15236
15237 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15238 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15239 Connection error during SSL handshake
15240
15241 Field Format Extract from the example above
15242 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15243 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15244 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15245 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15246 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15247
15248These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15249failures.
15250
15251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152528.3. Advanced logging options
15253-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015254
15255Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15256just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15257options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15258for more information about their usage.
15259
15260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152618.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15262------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015263
15264It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15265haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15266commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15267monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15268ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15269
15270 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15271 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15272 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15273 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15274
15275 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15276 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15277 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015278 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015279 such as other load-balancers.
15280
15281 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15282 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15283 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15284
15285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152868.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15287----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015288
15289The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15290what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15291or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15292"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15293just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15294log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15295after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15296is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15297with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15298with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15299
15300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153018.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15302------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015303
15304Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15305for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15306"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15307retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15308raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15309a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15310file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15311you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15312"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15313
15314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153158.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15316--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015317
15318Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15319multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15320them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15321"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15322logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15323error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15324and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15325too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15326useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15327alternative.
15328
15329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153308.4. Timing events
15331------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015332
15333Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15334reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15335the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15336frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015337mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15338addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15339
15340 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15341 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15342 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15343 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15344 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15345 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15346 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015347
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015348 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15349 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15350 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15351 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15352 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15353 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15354 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15355 nothing was received on the connection.
15356
15357 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15358 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15359 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15360 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15361 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15362 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15363 request typed by hand during a test.
15364
15365 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15366 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15367 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15368 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15369 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15370 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15371 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015372
15373 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15374 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15375 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15376 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15377 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15378
15379 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15380 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15381 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15382 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15383 connection never established.
15384
15385 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15386 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15387 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15388 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15389 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15390 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15391 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15392 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15393 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15394 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15395 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15396
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015397 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15398 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15399 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15400 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15401 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15402 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15403
15404 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15405
15406 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15407 "Ta" can never be negative.
15408
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015409 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15410 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015411 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15412 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015413 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015414
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015415 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015416
15417 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015418 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15419 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015420
15421These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15422protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15423that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015424due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15425"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15426that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015427
15428Most common cases :
15429
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015430 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15431 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15432 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15433 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15434 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15435 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15436 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15437 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15438 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15439 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15440 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015441 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015442
15443 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15444 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15445 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15446 of ms on remote networks.
15447
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015448 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15449 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15450 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015451
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015452 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15453 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15454 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15455 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15456 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15457 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15458 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15459 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15460 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015461
15462Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15463
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015464 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015465 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015466 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015467
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015468 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015469 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15470 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15471
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015472 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015473 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15474 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15475 flags.
15476
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015477 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15478 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015479 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15480 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15481 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15482 the client connection was maintained open.
15483
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015484 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015485 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015486 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015487 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15488
15489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154908.5. Session state at disconnection
15491-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015492
15493TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15494"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
154952-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15496each of which has a special meaning :
15497
15498 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15499 session to terminate :
15500
15501 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15502
15503 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15504 server explicitly refused it.
15505
15506 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15507 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15508 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15509 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015510 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15511
15512 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15513 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015514
15515 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15516 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15517 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15518 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15519 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15520
15521 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15522 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15523 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15524 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15525 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15526
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015527 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15528 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15529
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015530 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15531 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15532 backup connections when going up.
15533
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015534 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15535
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015536 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15537 send or receive data.
15538
15539 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15540 send or receive data.
15541
15542 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15543 with nothing left in the buffers.
15544
15545 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15546
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015547 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015548 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15549
15550 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15551 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15552 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15553 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15554 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15555
15556 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15557 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15558
15559 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15560 server (HTTP only).
15561
15562 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15563
15564 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15565 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15566 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15567
15568 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15569 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15570 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15571
15572 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15573
15574 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15575 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15576
15577 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15578 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15579 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15580
15581 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15582 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015583 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15584 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015585
15586 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15587 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15588 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15589 another server.
15590
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015591 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015592 server.
15593
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015594 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15595 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15596 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15597 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15598
15599 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15600 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15601 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15602 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15603
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015604 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15605 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15606 "use-server" rule).
15607
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015608 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15609
15610 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15611 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15612
15613 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15614
15615 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15616 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15617 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15618
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015619 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15620 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015621 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015622 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15623 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15624
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015625 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15626
15627 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15628 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15629
15630 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15631
15632 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15633
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015634The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15635was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015636helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15637starvation, attacks, etc...
15638
15639The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15640alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15641easier finding and understanding.
15642
15643 Flags Reason
15644
15645 -- Normal termination.
15646
15647 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15648 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15649 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15650 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15651
15652 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15653 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15654 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15655 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15656 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15657 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015658
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015659 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15660 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015661 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015662
15663 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15664 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15665 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15666
15667 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15668 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15669 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15670 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15671 the server takes too long to respond.
15672
15673 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15674 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15675 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15676 long a time to respond.
15677
15678 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15679 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15680 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15681 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015682 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15683 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015684
15685 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15686 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15687 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15688 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15689 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015690 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015691 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15692 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15693 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15694 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15695 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15696 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15697 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15698 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15699 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15700 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15701 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15702 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015703
15704 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15705 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015706 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15707 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15708 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15709 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015710
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015711 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15712 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015714 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015715 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15716 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15717 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15718 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15719 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15720
15721 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15722 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15723 503 or 504 here.
15724
15725 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15726 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15727 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15728 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15729 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15730
15731 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15732 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015733 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015734 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15735 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15736
15737 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15738 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15739 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15740 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15741 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15742 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15743 between haproxy and the server.
15744
15745 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15746 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15747 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15748 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15749 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15750 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15751 solution is to fix the application.
15752
15753 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15754 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15755 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15756 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15757 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15758 external attacks.
15759
15760 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15761 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015762 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015763 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15764 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15765
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015766 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15767 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15768 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015769 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15770 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015771
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015772 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15773 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15774 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15775 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015776 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15777 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15778 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15779 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15780 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015781
15782 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15783 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15784 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15785 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15786
15787 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15788 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15789 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15790 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15791
15792 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15793 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15794 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15795 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15796
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015797The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15798persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15799important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15800re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15801
15802 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15803
15804 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15805 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15806 set on a GET request.
15807
15808 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15809 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015810 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015811 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15812
15813 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15814 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15815 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15816
15817 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15818 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15819 already got a cookie.
15820
15821 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15822 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15823 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15824 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15825 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15826
15827 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15828 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15829 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15830
15831 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15832 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15833 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15834
15835 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15836 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15837
15838 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15839 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15840 then advertised in the response.
15841
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158438.6. Non-printable characters
15844-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015845
15846In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15847consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15848converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15849prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15850being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15851escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15852is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15853'}' when logging headers.
15854
15855Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15856issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15857containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15858
15859Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15860the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15861performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15862
15863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158648.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15865---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015866
15867Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15868achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015869section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015870cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15871the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15872the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015873locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015874not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15875user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15876a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15877wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15878
15879 Examples :
15880 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15881 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15882
15883 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15884 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15885
15886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15888---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015889
15890Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15891proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15892the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15893server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15894
15895Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15896response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015897section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015898
15899It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015900time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15901appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015902are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15903and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15904follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15905request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15906in the logs.
15907
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015908As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15909frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15910an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15911
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015912 Example :
15913 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15914 listen proxy-out
15915 mode http
15916 option httplog
15917 option logasap
15918 log global
15919 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15920
15921 # log the name of the virtual server
15922 capture request header Host len 20
15923
15924 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15925 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15926
15927 # log the beginning of the referrer
15928 capture request header Referer len 20
15929
15930 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15931 capture response header Server len 20
15932
15933 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15934 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15935
15936 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15937 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15938
15939 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15940 capture response header Via len 20
15941
15942 # log the URL location during a redirection
15943 capture response header Location len 20
15944
15945 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15946 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15947 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15948 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15949 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15950
15951 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15952 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15953 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15954 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015955 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015956
15957 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15958 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15959 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15960 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15961 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015962 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015963
15964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159658.9. Examples of logs
15966---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015967
15968These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15969them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15970reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15971
15972 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15973 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15974 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15975
15976 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15977 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15978
15979 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15980 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15981 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15982
15983 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15984 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15985
15986 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15987 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15988 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15989
15990 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015991 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015992 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15993 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15994
15995 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15996 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15997 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15998
15999 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16000 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016001 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016002 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16003 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16004 to return the 502 and not the server.
16005
16006 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016007 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016008
16009 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16010 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16011 Nothing was sent to any server.
16012
16013 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16014 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16015
16016 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16017 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16018 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16019 send a 408 return code to the client.
16020
16021 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16022 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16023
16024 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16025 5 seconds ("c----").
16026
16027 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16028 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016029 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016030
16031 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016032 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016033 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16034 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16035 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16036 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16037 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016038
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016039
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200160409. Supported filters
16041--------------------
16042
16043Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16044accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16045unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16046
16047See also : "filter"
16048
160499.1. Trace
16050----------
16051
16052filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
16053
16054 Arguments:
16055 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16056 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16057
16058 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16059 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16060 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16061 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16062
16063 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16064 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16065 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16066 amount of the parsed data.
16067
16068This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16069callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16070information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16071filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16072
16073Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16074tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16075a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16076
16077
160789.2. HTTP compression
16079---------------------
16080
16081filter compression
16082
16083The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16084keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16085when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16086use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16087used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16088filters evaluation order.
16089
16090See also : "compression"
16091
16092
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016093/*
16094 * Local variables:
16095 * fill-column: 79
16096 * End:
16097 */